Annual Statements Open main menu

TYSON FOODS, INC. - Annual Report: 2014 (Form 10-K)

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
[X]
Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
 
For the fiscal year ended
September 27, 2014
 
 
 
[ ]
Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
 
For the transition period from                          to                         
001-14704
(Commission File Number)
______________________________________________
TYSON FOODS, INC.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
______________________________________________
Delaware
 
71-0225165
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
 
 
 
2200 Don Tyson Parkway, Springdale, Arkansas
 
72762-6999
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
(Zip Code)
 
 
 
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code:
 
(479) 290-4000
Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of Each Class
 
Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered
Class A Common Stock, Par Value $0.10
 
New York Stock Exchange
Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: Not Applicable
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes [X] No [ ]
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes [ ] No [X]
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes [X] No [ ]
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes [X] No [ ]
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. [ ]
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer [X]
 
Accelerated filer [ ]
Non-accelerated filer [ ] (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
 
Smaller reporting company [ ]
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes [ ] No [X]




On March 29, 2014, the aggregate market value of the registrant’s Class A Common Stock, $0.10 par value (Class A stock), and Class B Common Stock, $0.10 par value (Class B stock), held by non-affiliates of the registrant was $11,778,761,908 and $466,236, respectively. Class B stock is not publicly listed for trade on any exchange or market system. However, Class B stock is convertible into Class A stock on a share-for-share basis, so the market value was calculated based on the market price of Class A stock.
On October 25, 2014, there were 305,656,663 shares of Class A stock and 70,010,805 shares of Class B stock outstanding.
INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
Portions of the registrant’s definitive Proxy Statement for the registrant’s Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held January 30, 2015, are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
TABLE OF CONTENTS 
 
 
PAGE
 
 
Item 1.
Item 1A.
Item 1B.
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.
 
 
 
 
 
Item 5.
Item 6.
Item 7.
Item 7A.
Item 8.
Item 9.
Item 9A.
Item 9B.
 
 
 
 
 
Item 10.
Item 11.
Item 12.
Item 13.
Item 14.
 
 
 
 
 
Item 15.

1



PART I
ITEM 1. BUSINESS
GENERAL
Founded in 1935, Tyson Foods, Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively, “Company,” “we,” “us” or “our”) are one of the world's largest producers of chicken, beef, pork and prepared foods that include leading brands such as Tyson®, Jimmy Dean®, Hillshire Farm®, Sara Lee® frozen bakery, Ball Park®, Wright®, Aidells® and State Fair®. Our operations are conducted in five segments: Chicken, Beef, Pork, Prepared Foods and International. Some of the key factors influencing our business are customer demand for our products; the ability to maintain and grow relationships with customers and introduce new and innovative products to the marketplace; accessibility of international markets; market prices for our products; the cost and availability of live cattle and hogs, raw materials, grain and feed ingredients; and operating efficiencies of our facilities.
We operate a fully vertically integrated chicken production process. Our integrated operations consist of breeding stock, contract growers, feed production, processing, further-processing, marketing and transportation of chicken and related allied products, including animal and pet food ingredients. Through our wholly-owned subsidiary, Cobb-Vantress, Inc. (Cobb), we are one of the leading poultry breeding stock suppliers in the world. Investing in breeding stock research and development allows us to breed into our flocks the characteristics found to be most desirable.
We also process live fed cattle and hogs and fabricate dressed beef and pork carcasses into primal and sub-primal meat cuts, case ready beef and pork and fully-cooked meats. In addition, we derive value from allied products such as hides and variety meats sold to further processors and others.
We produce a wide range of fresh, value-added, frozen and refrigerated food products. Our products are marketed and sold primarily by our sales staff to grocery retailers, grocery wholesalers, meat distributors, warehouse club stores, military commissaries, industrial food processing companies, chain restaurants or their distributors, live markets, international export companies and domestic distributors who serve restaurants, foodservice operations such as plant and school cafeterias, convenience stores, hospitals and other vendors. Additionally, sales to the military and a portion of sales to international markets are made through independent brokers and trading companies.
On August 28, 2014, we acquired and consolidated The Hillshire Brands Company ("Hillshire Brands"), a manufacturer and marketer of branded, convenient foods. The fiscal 2014 one month results from operations for Hillshire Brands are included in the Prepared Foods segment and in this 2014 Annual Report on Form 10-K. For further description of this transaction, refer to Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 3: Acquisitions and Dispositions.
FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF SEGMENTS
We operate in five segments: Chicken, Beef, Pork, Prepared Foods and International. During the second quarter of fiscal 2014, we
began reporting our International operation as a separate segment, which was previously included in our Chicken segment. Our International segment became a separate reportable segment as a result of changes to our internal financial reporting to align with previously announced executive leadership changes. All periods presented have been reclassified to reflect this change. Beef, Pork,
Prepared Foods and Other results were not impacted by this change. The contribution of each segment to net sales and operating income (loss), and the identifiable assets attributable to each segment, are set forth in Note 17: Segment Reporting of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
DESCRIPTION OF SEGMENTS
Chicken: Chicken includes our domestic operations related to raising and processing live chickens into fresh, frozen and value-added chicken products, as well as sales from allied products. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets. This segment also includes logistics operations to move products through our domestic supply chain and the global operations of our chicken breeding stock subsidiary.
Beef: Beef includes our operations related to processing live fed cattle and fabricating dressed beef carcasses into primal and sub-primal meat cuts and case-ready products. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets. This segment also includes sales from allied products such as hides and variety meats, as well as logistics operations to move products through the supply chain.
Pork: Pork includes our operations related to processing live market hogs and fabricating pork carcasses into primal and sub-primal cuts and case-ready products. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets. This segment also includes our live swine group, related allied product processing activities and logistics operations to move products through the supply chain.

2



Prepared Foods: Prepared Foods includes our operations related to manufacturing and marketing frozen and refrigerated food products and logistics operations to move products through the supply chain. Products primarily include pepperoni, bacon, sausage, beef and pork pizza toppings, pizza crusts, flour and corn tortilla products, appetizers, prepared meals, ethnic foods, soups, sauces, side dishes, meat dishes, breadsticks and processed meats. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets. As previously discussed, on August 28, 2014, we completed the acquisition of Hillshire Brands, a manufacturer and marketer of branded, convenient foods which includes brands such as Jimmy Dean®, Ball Park®, Hillshire Farm®, State Fair®, Van's®, Sara Lee® frozen bakery and Chef Pierre® pies as well as artisanal brands Aidells®, Gallo Salame®, and Golden Island® premium jerky. Hillshire Brands' one month results from operations for fiscal 2014 are included in the Prepared Foods segment.
International: International includes our foreign operations primarily related to raising and processing live chickens into fresh, frozen and value-added chicken products in Brazil, China, India and Mexico. Products are marketed in each respective country to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains, noncommercial foodservice establishments and live markets, as well as to other international export markets.
On July 28, 2014, we announced our plan to sell our Brazil and Mexico operations, part of our International segment, to JBS SA ("JBS") for $575 million in cash. We expect to complete the sale of our Brazil operation in the first quarter of fiscal 2015. The sale of our Mexico operation is pending the necessary government approvals and is expected to close in the first half of fiscal 2015. As a result, we have reclassified the assets and liabilities related to Mexico and Brazil to assets and liabilities held for sale. For further description of this transaction, refer to Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 3: Acquisitions and Dispositions.
RAW MATERIALS AND SOURCES OF SUPPLY
Chicken: The primary raw materials used in our domestic chicken operations are corn and soybean meal used as feed and live chickens raised primarily by independent contract growers. Our vertically-integrated chicken process begins with the grandparent breeder flocks and ends with broilers for processing. Breeder flocks (i.e., grandparents) are raised to maturity in grandparent growing and laying farms where fertile eggs are produced. Fertile eggs are incubated at the grandparent hatchery and produce pullets (i.e., parents). Pullets are sent to breeder houses, and the resulting eggs are sent to our hatcheries. Once chicks have hatched, they are sent to broiler farms. There, contract growers care for and raise the chicks according to our standards, with advice from our technical service personnel, until the broilers reach the desired processing weight. Adult chickens are transported to processing plants where they are slaughtered and converted into finished products, which are then sent to distribution centers and delivered to customers.
We operate our own feed mills to produce scientifically-formulated feeds. In fiscal 2014, corn, soybean meal and other feed ingredients were major production costs, representing roughly 68% of our cost of growing a live chicken domestically. In addition to feed ingredients to grow the chickens, we use cooking ingredients, packaging materials and cryogenic agents. We believe our sources of supply for these materials are adequate for our present needs, and we do not anticipate any difficulty in acquiring these materials in the future. While we produce nearly all our inventory of breeder chickens and live broilers, we also purchase live, ice-packed or deboned chicken to meet production and sales requirements.
Beef: The primary raw materials used in our beef operations are live cattle. We do not have facilities of our own to raise cattle but employ cattle buyers located throughout cattle producing areas who visit independent feed yards and public auctions and buy live cattle on the open spot market. These buyers are trained to select high quality animals, and we continually measure their performance. We also enter into various risk-sharing and procurement arrangements with producers to secure a supply of livestock for our facilities. Although we generally expect adequate supply of live cattle in the regions we operate, there may be periods of imbalance in supply and demand.
Pork: The primary raw materials used in our pork operations are live hogs. The majority of our live hog supply is obtained through various procurement relationships with independent producers. We employ hog buyers who make purchase agreements of various time durations as well as purchase hogs on a daily basis, generally a few days before the animals are processed. These buyers are trained to select high quality animals, and we continually measure their performance. We believe the supply of live hogs is adequate for our present needs. Additionally, we raise a small number of weanling swine to sell to independent finishers and supply a minimal amount of market hogs and live swine for our own processing needs.
Prepared Foods: The primary raw materials used in our prepared foods operations are commodity based raw materials, including chicken, beef, pork, turkey, corn, flour, vegetables and other cooking ingredients. Some of these raw materials are provided by our other segments, while others may be purchased from numerous suppliers and manufacturers. We believe the sources of supply of raw materials are adequate for our present needs.

3



International: The primary raw materials used in our international chicken operations are corn and soybean meal used as feed and live chickens raised primarily by independent contract growers and company-owned farms. Pullets are sent to breeder houses, and the resulting eggs are sent to independent and company-owned hatcheries. Once chicks have hatched, they are sent to broiler farms. There, contract growers or employees care for and raise the chicks according to our standards, with advice from our technical service personnel, until the broilers reach the desired processing weight. Adult chickens are transported to processing plants where they are slaughtered and converted into finished products, which are then sent to distribution centers and delivered to customers.
We operate our own feed mills to produce scientifically-formulated feeds and procure outside feed at times to meet our production needs. In fiscal 2014, corn, soybean meal and other feed ingredients were major production costs, representing approximately two-thirds of our cost of growing a live chicken. In addition to feed ingredients to grow the chickens, we use cooking ingredients, packaging materials and cryogenic agents. We believe our sources of supply for these materials are adequate for our present needs, and we do not anticipate any difficulty in acquiring these materials in the future. We also purchase live, ice-packed or fresh chicken to meet production and sales requirements.
SEASONAL DEMAND
Demand for chicken, beef, and certain prepared foods products, such as hot dogs and smoked sausage, generally increases during the spring and summer months and generally decreases during the winter months. Pork and certain other prepared foods products, such as prepared meals, meat dishes, appetizers, frozen pies and breakfast sausage generally experience increased demand during the winter months, primarily due to the holiday season, while demand generally decreases during the spring and summer months.
CUSTOMERS
Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. accounted for 14.6% of our fiscal 2014 consolidated sales. Sales to Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. were included in all of our segments. Any extended discontinuance of sales to this customer could, if not replaced, have a material impact on our operations. No other single customer or customer group represented more than 10% of fiscal 2014 consolidated sales.
COMPETITION
Our food products compete with those of other food producers and processors and certain prepared food manufacturers. Additionally, our food products compete in markets around the world.
We seek to achieve a leading market position for our products via our principal marketing and competitive strategy, which includes:
identifying target markets for value-added products;
concentrating production, sales and marketing efforts to appeal to and enhance demand from those markets; and
utilizing our national distribution systems and customer support services.
Past efforts indicate customer demand can be increased and sustained through application of our marketing strategy, as supported by our distribution systems. The principal competitive elements are price, product safety and quality, brand identification, innovation, breadth and depth of product offerings, availability of products, customer service and credit terms.
FOREIGN OPERATIONS
We sold products in approximately 130 countries in fiscal 2014. Major sales markets include Brazil, Canada, Central America, China, the European Union, Japan, Mexico, the Middle East, South Korea, Taiwan, and Vietnam.
We have the following foreign operations:
Tyson de Mexico, a Mexican subsidiary, is a vertically-integrated poultry production company. The sale of this subsidiary to JBS is pending necessary government approvals in Mexico and is expected to close in the first half of fiscal 2015.
Cobb-Vantress, a chicken breeding stock subsidiary, has business interests in Argentina, Brazil, China, the Dominican Republic, India, Japan, the Netherlands, Peru, the Philippines, Russia, Spain, Sri Lanka, Thailand, Turkey, the United Kingdom and Venezuela.
Tyson do Brazil, a Brazilian subsidiary, is a vertically-integrated poultry production operation. We expect to complete the sale of this subsidiary to JBS in the first quarter of fiscal 2015.
Tyson Rizhao, located in Rizhao, China, is a vertically-integrated poultry production operation.
Tyson Dalong, a joint venture in China in which we have a majority interest, is a chicken further processing facility.
Tyson Nantong, located in Nantong, China, is a vertically-integrated poultry production operation.
Godrej Tyson Foods, a joint venture in India in which we have a majority interest, is a poultry processing business.
We continue to evaluate growth opportunities in foreign countries. Additional information regarding export sales, long-lived assets located in foreign countries and income (loss) from foreign operations is set forth in Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 17: Segment Reporting and Note 9: Income Taxes.

4



RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
We conduct continuous research and development activities to improve product development, to automate manual processes in our processing plants and growout operations, and to improve chicken breeding stock. Our Discovery Center includes 19 research kitchens and a USDA-inspected pilot plant. The Discovery Center enables us to bring new market-leading retail and foodservice products to the customer quickly and efficiently. We also lease an approximately 73,000 square foot research and development facility outside Chicago, Illinois assumed in our Hillshire Brands acquisition. Research and development costs totaled $52 million, $50 million, and $43 million in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
ENVIRONMENTAL REGULATION AND FOOD SAFETY
Our facilities for processing chicken, beef, pork, turkey and prepared foods, milling feed and housing live chickens and swine are subject to a variety of international, federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations, which include provisions relating to the discharge of materials into the environment and generally provide for protection of the environment. We believe we are in substantial compliance with such applicable laws and regulations and are not aware of any violations of such laws and regulations likely to result in material penalties or material increases in compliance costs. The cost of compliance with such laws and regulations has not had a material adverse effect on our capital expenditures, earnings or competitive position, and except as described below, is not anticipated to have a material adverse effect in the future.
Congress and the United States Environmental Protection Agency are considering various options to control greenhouse gas emissions. It is unclear at this time when or if such options will be finalized, or what the final form may be. Due to the uncertainty surrounding this issue, it is premature to speculate on the specific nature of impacts that imposition of greenhouse gas emission controls would have on us, and whether such impacts would have a material adverse effect.
We work to ensure our products meet high standards of food safety and quality. In addition to our own internal Food Safety and Quality Assurance oversight and review, our chicken, beef, pork and prepared foods products are subject to inspection prior to distribution, primarily by the United States Department of Agriculture (USDA) and the United States Food and Drug Administration (FDA). We are also participants in the United States Hazard Analysis Critical Control Point (HACCP) program and are subject to the Sanitation Standard Operating Procedures and the Public Health Security and Bioterrorism Preparedness and Response Act of 2002. Additionally, our International operation is subject to various other food safety and quality assurance oversight and review.
EMPLOYEES AND LABOR RELATIONS
As of September 27, 2014, we employed approximately 124,000 employees. Approximately 108,000 employees were employed in the United States and 16,000 employees were in foreign countries, primarily Brazil, China and Mexico. Approximately 32,000 employees in the United States were subject to collective bargaining agreements with various labor unions, with approximately 18% of those employees included under agreements expiring in fiscal 2015. The remaining agreements expire over the next several years. Approximately 10,000 employees in foreign countries were subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe our overall relations with our workforce are good.
MARKETING AND DISTRIBUTION
Our principal marketing objective is to be the primary provider of chicken, beef, pork and prepared foods products for our customers and consumers. We build the Tyson®, Jimmy Dean®, Hillshire Farm®, Sara Lee® frozen bakery, Ball Park®, Wright®, Aidells® and State Fair® brands while supporting strong regional and emerging brands primarily through well-defined product-specific advertising, marketing, and public relations efforts focused toward key consumer targets with specific needs. We identify distinct markets and business opportunities through continuous consumer and market research. These efforts are designed to present key products as everyday solutions to relevant consumer problems; thereby becoming part of regular eating routines. We utilize our national distribution system and customer support services to achieve the leading market position for our products.
We have the ability to produce and ship fresh, frozen and refrigerated products worldwide. Domestically, our distribution system extends to a broad network of food distributors and is supported by our owned or leased cold storage warehouses, public cold storage facilities and our transportation system. Our distribution centers accumulate fresh and frozen products so we can fill and consolidate partial-truckload orders into full truckloads, thereby decreasing shipping costs while increasing customer service. In addition, we provide our customers a wide selection of products that do not require large volume orders. Our distribution system enables us to supply large or small quantities of products to meet customer requirements anywhere in the continental United States. Internationally, we utilize both rail and truck refrigerated transportation to domestic ports, where consolidations take place to transport to foreign destinations.

5



PATENTS AND TRADEMARKS
We have filed a number of patents and trademarks relating to our processes and products that either have been approved or are in the process of application. Because we do a significant amount of brand name and product line advertising to promote our products, we consider the protection of our trademarks to be important to our marketing efforts. We also have developed non-public proprietary information regarding our production processes and other product-related matters. We utilize internal procedures and safeguards to protect the confidentiality of such information and, where appropriate, seek patent and/or trademark protection for the technology we utilize.
INDUSTRY PRACTICES
Our agreements with customers are generally short-term, primarily due to the nature of our products, industry practices and fluctuations in supply, demand and price for such products. In certain instances where we are selling further processed products to large customers, we may enter into written agreements whereby we will act as the exclusive or preferred supplier to the customer, with pricing terms that are either fixed or variable.
AVAILABILITY OF SEC FILINGS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE DOCUMENTS ON INTERNET WEBSITE
We maintain an internet website for investors at http://ir.tyson.com. On this website, we make available, free of charge, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, XBRL (eXtensible Business Reporting Language) reports, and all amendments to any of those reports, as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such reports with, or furnish to, the Securities and Exchange Commission. Also available on the website for investors are the Corporate Governance Principles, Audit Committee charter, Compensation and Leadership Development Committee charter, Governance and Nominating Committee charter, Strategy and Acquisitions Committee charter, Code of Conduct and Whistleblower Policy. Our corporate governance documents are available in print, free of charge to any shareholder who requests them.
CAUTIONARY STATEMENTS RELEVANT TO FORWARD-LOOKING INFORMATION FOR THE PURPOSE OF “SAFE HARBOR” PROVISIONS OF THE PRIVATE SECURITIES LITIGATION REFORM ACT OF 1995
Certain information in this report constitutes forward-looking statements. Such forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, current views and estimates of our outlook for fiscal 2015, other future economic circumstances, industry conditions in domestic and international markets, our performance and financial results (e.g., debt levels, return on invested capital, value-added product growth, capital expenditures, tax rates, access to foreign markets and dividend policy). These forward-looking statements are subject to a number of factors and uncertainties that could cause our actual results and experiences to differ materially from anticipated results and expectations expressed in such forward-looking statements. We wish to caution readers not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date made. We undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.
Among the factors that may cause actual results and experiences to differ from anticipated results and expectations expressed in such forward-looking statements are the following: (i) the effect of, or changes in, general economic conditions; (ii) fluctuations in the cost and availability of inputs and raw materials, such as live cattle, live swine, feed grains (including corn and soybean meal) and energy; (iii) market conditions for finished products, including competition from other global and domestic food processors, supply and pricing of competing products and alternative proteins and demand for alternative proteins; (iv) successful rationalization of existing facilities and operating efficiencies of the facilities; (v) risks associated with our commodity purchasing activities; (vi) access to foreign markets together with foreign economic conditions, including currency fluctuations, import/export restrictions and foreign politics; (vii) outbreak of a livestock disease (such as avian influenza (AI) or bovine spongiform encephalopathy (BSE)), which could have an adverse effect on livestock we own, the availability of livestock we purchase, consumer perception of certain protein products or our ability to access certain domestic and foreign markets; (viii) changes in availability and relative costs of labor and contract growers and our ability to maintain good relationships with employees, labor unions, contract growers and independent producers providing us livestock; (ix) issues related to food safety, including costs resulting from product recalls, regulatory compliance and any related claims or litigation; (x) changes in consumer preference and diets and our ability to identify and react to consumer trends; (xi) significant marketing plan changes by large customers or loss of one or more large customers; (xii) adverse results from litigation; (xiii) impacts on our operations caused by factors and forces beyond our control, such as natural disasters, fire, bioterrorism, pandemic or extreme weather; (xiv) risks associated with leverage, including cost increases due to rising interest rates or changes in debt ratings or outlook; (xv) compliance with and changes to regulations and laws (both domestic and foreign), including changes in accounting standards, tax laws, environmental laws, agricultural laws and occupational, health and safety laws; (xvi) our ability to make effective acquisitions or joint ventures and successfully integrate newly acquired businesses into existing operations; (xvii) failures or security breaches of our information technology systems; (xviii) effectiveness of advertising and marketing programs; and (xix) those factors listed under Item 1A. “Risk Factors.”


6



ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS
These risks, which should be considered carefully with the information provided elsewhere in this report, could materially adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently deem to be immaterial also may materially adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
The integration of The Hillshire Brands Company may be more difficult, costly or time consuming than expected, and the acquisition may not result in any or all of the anticipated benefits, including cost synergies.
The success of the acquisition of Hillshire Brands, including the realization of the anticipated benefits, will depend in part on our ability to successfully integrate Hillshire Brands’ businesses in an efficient and effective manner. We may not be able to accomplish this integration process smoothly or successfully. The necessity of coordinating geographically separated organizations, systems and facilities and addressing possible differences in business backgrounds, corporate cultures and management philosophies may increase the difficulties of integration. Failure to effectively integrate the businesses could adversely impact the expected benefits of the acquisition, including cost synergies stemming from supply chain efficiencies, merchandising activities and overlapping general and administrative functions.
The integration of two large companies is complex, and we will be required to devote significant management attention and incur substantial costs to integrate Hillshire Brands’ and Tyson’s business practices, policies, cultures and operations. This diversion of our management’s attention from day-to-day business operations and the execution and pursuit of strategic plans and initiatives could result in performance shortfalls, which could adversely impact the combined company’s business, operations and financial results. The integration process could also result in the loss of key employees, which could adversely impact the combined company’s future financial results.
Furthermore, during the integration planning process, we may encounter additional challenges and difficulties, including those related to, without limitation, managing a larger combined company; streamlining supply chains, consolidating corporate and administrative infrastructures and eliminating overlapping operations; retaining our existing vendors and customers; unanticipated issues in integrating information technology, communications and other systems; and unforeseen and unexpected liabilities related to the acquisition of Hillshire Brands’ business. Delays encountered in the integration could adversely impact the business, financial condition and operations of the combined company.
We continue to evaluate our estimates of synergies to be realized from the Hillshire Brands acquisition and refine them, so that our actual cost-savings could differ materially from our current estimates. Actual cost-savings, the costs required to realize the cost-savings and the source of the cost-savings could differ materially from our estimates, and we cannot assure you that we will achieve the full amount of cost-savings on the schedule anticipated or at all or that these cost-savings programs will not have other adverse effects on our business. In light of these uncertainties, you should not place undue reliance on our estimated cost-savings.
Finally, we may not be able to achieve the targeted operating or long-term strategic benefits of the Hillshire Brands acquisition or could incur higher transition costs. An inability to realize the full extent of, or any of, the anticipated benefits of the Hillshire Brands acquisition, as well as any delays encountered in the integration process, could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
Fluctuations in commodity prices and in the availability of raw materials, especially feed grains, live cattle, live swine and other inputs could negatively impact our earnings.
Our results of operations and financial condition, as well as the selling prices for our products, are dependent upon the cost and supply of commodities and raw materials such as pork, beef, poultry, corn, soybean, packaging materials and energy and, to a lesser extent, cheese, fruit, seasoning blends, flour, corn syrup, corn oils, butter and sugar. Corn, soybean meal and other feed ingredients, for instance, represented roughly 68% of our cost of growing a live chicken in fiscal 2014. Production and pricing of these commodities are determined by constantly changing market forces of supply and demand over which we have limited or no control. Such factors include, among other things, weather patterns throughout the world, outbreaks of disease, the global level of supply inventories and demand for grains and other feed ingredients, as well as agricultural and energy policies of domestic and foreign governments.
Volatility in our commodity and raw material costs directly impact our gross margin and profitability. The company’s objective is to offset commodity price increases with pricing actions over time. However, we may not be able to increase our product prices enough to sufficiently offset increased raw material costs due to consumer price sensitivity or the pricing postures of our competitors. In addition, if we increase prices to offset higher costs, we could experience lower demand for our products and sales volumes. Conversely, decreases in our commodity and other input costs may create pressure on us to decrease our prices. While we use derivative financial instruments, primarily futures and options, to reduce the effect of changing prices and as a mechanism to procure the underlying commodity, we do not fully hedge against changes in commodities prices.
Over time, if we are unable to price our products to cover increased costs, to offset operating cost increases with continuous improvement savings or are not successful in our commodity hedging program, then commodity and raw material price volatility or increases could materially and adversely affect our profitability, financial condition and results of operations.

7



The prices we receive for our products may fluctuate due to competition from other food producers and processors.
The food industry in general is intensely competitive. We face competition from other food producers and processors that have various product ranges and geographic reach. Some of the factors on which we compete include: pricing, product safety and quality, brand identification, innovation, breadth and depth of product offerings, availability of our products and competing products, customer service, and credit terms.
From time to time in response to these competitive pressures or to maintain market share, we may need to reduce the prices for some of our products or increase or reallocate spending on marketing, advertising and promotions and new product innovation. Such pressures also may restrict our ability to increase prices in response to raw material and other cost increases. Any reduction in prices as a result of competitive pressures, or any failure to increase prices to offset cost increases, could harm our profit margins. If we reduce prices but we cannot increase sales volumes to offset the price changes, then our financial condition and results of operations will suffer. Alternatively, if we do not reduce our prices and our competitors seek advantage through pricing or promotional changes, our revenues and market share would be adversely affected.
Outbreaks of livestock diseases can adversely impact our ability to conduct our operations and demand for our products.
Demand for our products can be adversely impacted by outbreaks of livestock diseases, which can have a significant impact on our financial results. Efforts are taken to control disease risks by adherence to good production practices and extensive precautionary measures designed to ensure the health of livestock. However, outbreaks of disease and other events, which may be beyond our control, either in our own livestock or cattle and hogs owned by independent producers who sell livestock to us, could significantly affect demand for our products, consumer perceptions of certain protein products, the availability of livestock for purchase by us and our ability to conduct our operations. Moreover, the outbreak of livestock diseases, particularly in our Chicken segment, could have a significant effect on the livestock we own by requiring us to, among other things, destroy any affected livestock. Furthermore, an outbreak of disease could result in governmental restrictions on the import and export of our products to or from our suppliers, facilities or customers. This could also result in negative publicity that may have an adverse effect on our ability to market our products successfully and on our financial results.
We are subject to risks associated with our international activities, which could negatively affect our sales to customers in foreign countries, as well as our operations and assets in such countries.
In fiscal 2014, we sold products to approximately 130 countries. Major sales markets include Brazil, Canada, Central America, China, the European Union, Japan, Mexico, the Middle East, South Korea, Taiwan, and Vietnam. Our sales to customers in foreign countries for fiscal 2014 totaled $6.3 billion, of which $4.7 billion related to export sales from the United States. In addition, we had approximately $324 million of long-lived assets located in foreign countries, primarily Brazil, China, and India, at the end of fiscal 2014.
As a result, we are subject to various risks and uncertainties relating to international sales and operations, including:
imposition of tariffs, quotas, trade barriers and other trade protection measures imposed by foreign countries regarding the importation of poultry, beef, pork and prepared foods products, in addition to import or export licensing requirements imposed by various foreign countries;
closing of borders by foreign countries to the import of poultry, beef and pork products due to animal disease or other perceived health or safety issues;
impact of currency exchange rate fluctuations between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies, particularly the Brazilian real, the British pound sterling, the Canadian dollar, the Chinese renminbi, the European euro, the Indian rupee and the Mexican peso;
political and economic conditions;
difficulties and costs to comply with, and enforcement of remedies under, a wide variety of complex domestic and international laws, treaties and regulations, including, without limitation, the United States Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and economic and trade sanctions enforced by the United States Department of the Treasury’s Office of Foreign Assets Control;
different regulatory structures and unexpected changes in regulatory environments;
tax rates that may exceed those in the United States and earnings that may be subject to withholding requirements and incremental taxes upon repatriation;
potentially negative consequences from changes in tax laws; and
distribution costs, disruptions in shipping or reduced availability of freight transportation.
Negative consequences relating to these risks and uncertainties could jeopardize or limit our ability to transact business in one or more of those markets where we operate or in other developing markets and could adversely affect our financial results.
We depend on the availability of, and good relations with, our employees.
We have approximately 124,000 employees, approximately 42,000 of whom are covered by collective bargaining agreements or are members of labor unions. Our operations depend on the availability and relative costs of labor and maintaining good relations with employees and the labor unions. If we fail to maintain good relations with our employees or with the labor unions, we may experience labor strikes or work stoppages, which could adversely affect our financial results.

8



We depend on contract growers and independent producers to supply us with livestock.
We contract primarily with independent contract growers to raise the live chickens and turkeys processed in our poultry operations. A majority of our cattle and hogs are purchased from independent producers who sell livestock to us under marketing contracts or on the open market. If we do not attract and maintain contracts with growers or maintain marketing and purchasing relationships with independent producers, our production operations could be negatively affected.
If our products become contaminated, we may be subject to product liability claims and product recalls.
Our products may be subject to contamination by disease-producing organisms or pathogens, such as Listeria monocytogenes, Salmonella and E. coli. These organisms and pathogens are found generally in the environment; therefore, there is a risk that one or more, as a result of food processing, could be present in our products. These organisms and pathogens also can be introduced to our products as a result of improper handling at the further processing, foodservice or consumer level. These risks may be controlled, but may not be eliminated, by adherence to good manufacturing practices and finished product testing. We have little, if any, control over handling procedures once our products have been shipped for distribution. Even an inadvertent shipment of contaminated products may be a violation of law and may lead to increased risk of exposure to product liability claims, increased scrutiny and penalties, including injunctive relief and plant closings, by federal and state regulatory agencies, and adverse publicity, which could exacerbate the associated negative consumer reaction. Any of these occurrences may have an adverse effect on our financial results.
In addition, we may be required to recall some of our products if they spoil, become contaminated, are tampered with or are mislabeled. A widespread product recall could result in significant losses due to the costs of a recall, the destruction of product inventory and lost sales due to the unavailability of product for a period of time. Such a product recall also could result in adverse publicity, damage to our reputation, and a loss of consumer confidence in our products, which could have a material adverse effect on our business results and the value of our brands.
Changes in consumer preference and failure to maintain favorable consumer perception of our brands and products could negatively impact our business.
The food industry in general is subject to changing consumer trends, demands and preferences. Trends within the food industry change often, and failure to identify and react to changes in these trends could lead to, among other things, reduced demand and price reductions for our brands and products. We strive to respond to consumer preferences and social expectations, but we may not be successful in our efforts.
We could be adversely affected if consumers lose confidence in the safety and quality of certain food products or ingredients, or the food safety system generally. Prolonged negative perceptions concerning the health implications of certain food products or ingredients or loss of confidence in the food safety system generally could influence consumer preferences and acceptance of some of our products and marketing programs. Continued negative perceptions and failure to satisfy consumer preferences could materially and adversely affect our product sales, financial condition and results of operations.
We have a number of iconic brands with significant value. Maintaining and continually enhancing the value of these brands is critical to the success of our business. Brand value is based in large part on consumer perceptions. Success in promoting and enhancing brand value depends in large part on our ability to provide high-quality products. Brand value could diminish significantly due to a number of factors, including consumer perception that we have acted in an irresponsible manner, adverse publicity about our products (whether or not valid), our failure to maintain the quality of our products, the failure of our products to deliver consistently positive consumer experiences or the products becoming unavailable to consumers.
Failure to continually innovate and successfully launch new products and maintain our brand image through marketing investment could adversely impact our operating results.
Our financial success is dependent on anticipating changes in consumer preferences and dietary habits and successfully developing and launching new products and product extensions that consumers want. We devote significant resources to new product development and product extensions, however we may not be successful in developing innovative new products or our new products may not be commercially successful. To the extent we are not able to effectively gauge the direction of our key markets and successfully identify, develop, manufacture and market new or improved products in these changing markets, our financial results and our competitive position will suffer. In addition, our introduction of new products or product extensions may generate litigation or other legal proceedings against us by competitors claiming infringement of their intellectual property or other rights, which could negatively impact our results of operations.
We also seek to maintain and extend the image of our brands through marketing investments, including advertising, consumer promotions and trade spend. Due to inherent risks in the marketplace associated with advertising, promotions and new product introductions, including uncertainties about trade and consumer acceptance, our marketing investments may not prove successful in maintaining or increasing our market share and could result in lower sales and profits. Continuing global focus on health and wellness, including weight management, and increasing media attention to the role of food marketing could adversely affect our brand image or lead to stricter regulations and greater scrutiny of food marketing practices.

9



Our success in maintaining, extending and expanding our brand image also depends on our ability to adapt to a rapidly changing media environment, including our increasing reliance on social media and online dissemination of advertising campaigns. The growing use of social and digital media increases the speed and extent that information or misinformation and opinions can be shared.
We are subject to a variety of legal and regulatory restrictions on how and to whom we market our products, for instance marketing to children, which may limit our ability to maintain or extend our brand image. Negative posts or comments about us, our brands or our products on social or digital media could seriously damage our reputation and brand image. If we do not maintain or extend our brand image, then our product sales, financial condition and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected.
Failure to leverage our brand value propositions to compete against private label products, especially during economic downturn, may adversely affect our profitability.
In many product categories, we compete not only with other widely advertised branded products, but also with private label products that generally are sold at lower prices. Consumers are more likely to purchase our products if they believe that our products provide a higher quality and greater value than less expensive alternatives. If the difference in quality between our brands and private label products narrows, or if there is a perception of such a narrowing, consumers may choose not to buy our products at prices that are profitable for us. In addition, in periods of economic uncertainty, consumers tend to purchase more lower-priced private label or other economy brands. To the extent this occurs, we could experience a reduction in the sales volume of our higher margin products or a shift in our product mix to lower margin offerings. In addition, in times of economic uncertainty, consumers reduce the amount of food that they consume away from home at our foodservice customers, which in turn reduces our product sales.
Our level of indebtedness and the terms of our indebtedness could negatively impact our business and liquidity position.
Our indebtedness, including borrowings under our revolving credit facility, may increase from time to time for various reasons, including fluctuations in operating results, working capital needs, capital expenditures and possible acquisitions, joint ventures or other significant initiatives. Our consolidated indebtedness level could adversely affect our business because:
it may limit or impair our ability to obtain financing in the future;
our credit ratings (or any decrease to our credit ratings) could restrict or impede our ability to access capital markets at desired interest rates and increase our borrowing costs;
it may reduce our flexibility to respond to changing business and economic conditions or to take advantage of business opportunities that may arise;
a portion of our cash flow from operations must be dedicated to interest payments on our indebtedness and is not available for other purposes; and
it may restrict our ability to pay dividends.
Our revolving credit facility contains affirmative and negative covenants that, among other things, may limit or restrict our ability to: create liens and encumbrances; incur debt; merge, dissolve, liquidate or consolidate; make acquisitions and investments; dispose of or transfer assets; change the nature of our business; engage in certain transactions with affiliates; and enter into hedging transactions, in each case, subject to certain qualifications and exceptions. In addition, we are required to maintain minimum interest expense coverage and maximum debt to capitalization ratios.
Our senior notes and term loans also contain affirmative and negative covenants that, among other things, may limit or restrict our ability to: create liens; engage in certain sale/leaseback transactions; and engage in certain consolidations, mergers and sales of assets.
An impairment in the carrying value of our goodwill or indefinite life intangible assets could negatively impact our consolidated results of operations and net worth.
Goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets are initially recorded at fair value and not amortized, but are reviewed for impairment at least annually or more frequently if impairment indicators arise. In assessing the carrying value of goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets, we make estimates and assumptions about sales, operating margins, growth rates, royalty rates and discount rates based on budgets, business plans, economic projections, anticipated future cash flows and marketplace data. There are inherent uncertainties related to these factors and management’s judgment in applying these factors. Goodwill valuations have been calculated principally using an income approach based on the present value of future cash flows of each reporting unit and are believed to reflect market participant views which would exist in an exit transaction. Indefinite life intangible asset valuations have been calculated principally using relief-from-royalty and excess earnings approaches and are believed to reflect market participant views which would exist in an exit transaction. Under these valuation approaches, we are required to make various judgmental assumptions about appropriate discount rates. Disruptions in global credit and other financial markets and deterioration of economic conditions, could, among other things, cause us to increase the discount rate used in the valuations. We could be required to evaluate the recoverability of goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets prior to the annual assessment if we experience disruptions to the business, unexpected significant declines in operating results, divestiture of a significant component of our business or sustained market capitalization declines. These types of events and the resulting analyses could result in impairment charges in the future, which could be substantial. As of September 27, 2014, we had $10.8 billion of goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets, which represented approximately 45% of total assets.

10



New or more stringent domestic and international government regulations could impose material costs on us and could adversely affect our business.
Our operations are subject to extensive federal, state and foreign laws and regulations by authorities that oversee food safety standards and processing, packaging, storage, distribution, advertising, labeling and export of our products. See “Environmental Regulation and Food Safety” in Item 1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Changes in laws or regulations that impose additional regulatory requirements on us could increase our cost of doing business or restrict our actions, causing our results of operations to be adversely affected. For example, increased governmental interest in advertising practices may result in regulations that could require us to change or restrict our advertising practices.
Increased government regulations to limit carbon dioxide and other greenhouse gas emissions as a result of concern over climate change may result in increased compliance costs, capital expenditures and other financial obligations for us. We use natural gas, diesel fuel and electricity in the manufacturing and distribution of our products. Legislation or regulation affecting these inputs could materially affect our profitability. In addition, climate change could affect our ability to procure needed commodities at costs and in quantities we currently experience and may require us to make additional unplanned capital expenditures.
Legal claims, other regulatory enforcement actions, or failure to comply with applicable legal standards or requirements could affect our product sales, reputation and profitability.
We operate in a highly regulated environment with constantly evolving legal and regulatory frameworks. Consequently, we are subject to heightened risk of legal claims or other regulatory enforcement actions. Although we have implemented policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance with existing laws and regulations, there can be no assurance that our employees, contractors, or agents will not violate our policies and procedures. Moreover, a failure to maintain effective control processes could lead to violations, unintentional or otherwise, of laws and regulations. Legal claims or regulatory enforcement actions arising out of our failure or alleged failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations could subject us to civil and criminal penalties that could materially and adversely affect our product sales, reputation, financial condition and results of operations. Loss of or failure to obtain necessary permits and registrations could delay or prevent us from meeting current product demand, introducing new products, building new facilities or acquiring new businesses and could adversely affect operating results.
The Company is subject to stringent environmental regulation and potentially subject to environmental litigation, proceedings, and investigations.
Our past and present business operations and ownership and operation of real property are subject to stringent federal, state, and local environmental laws and regulations pertaining to the discharge of materials into the environment, and the handling and disposition of wastes (including solid and hazardous wastes) or otherwise relating to protection of the environment. Compliance with these laws and regulations, and the ability to comply with any modifications to these laws and regulations, is material to our business. New matters or sites may be identified in the future that will require additional investigation, assessment, or expenditures. In addition, some of our facilities have been in operation for many years and, over time, we and other prior operators of these facilities may have generated and disposed of wastes that now may be considered hazardous. Future discovery of contamination of property underlying or in the vicinity of our present or former properties or manufacturing facilities and/or waste disposal sites could require us to incur additional expenses. The occurrence of any of these events, the implementation of new laws and regulations, or stricter interpretation of existing laws or regulations, could adversely affect our financial results.
Failures or security breaches of our information technology systems could disrupt our operations and negatively impact our business.
Information technology is an important part of our business operations and we increasingly rely on information technology systems to manage business data and increase efficiencies in our production and distribution facilities and inventory management processes. We also use information technology to process financial information and results of operations for internal reporting purposes and to comply with regulatory, legal and tax requirements. In addition, we depend on information technology for digital marketing and electronic communications between our facilities, personnel, customers and suppliers. Like other companies, our information technology systems may be vulnerable to a variety of interruptions, including during the process of upgrading or replacing software, databases or components thereof, natural disasters, terrorist attacks, telecommunications failures, computer viruses, cyber-attacks, hackers, unauthorized access attempts and other security issues. We have implemented technology security initiatives and disaster recovery plans to mitigate our exposure to these risks, but these measures may not be adequate. Any significant failure of our systems, including failures that prevent our systems from functioning as intended, could cause transaction errors, processing inefficiencies, loss of customers and sales, have negative consequences on our employees and our business partners and have a negative impact on our operations or business reputation.
In addition, if we are unable to prevent security breaches, we may suffer financial and reputational damage or penalties because of the unauthorized disclosure of confidential information belonging to us or to our partners, customers, consumers or suppliers. In addition, the disclosure of non-public sensitive information through external media channels could lead to the loss of intellectual property or damage our reputation and brand image.

11



If we pursue strategic acquisitions or divestitures, we may not be able to successfully consummate favorable transactions or successfully integrate acquired businesses.
We periodically evaluate potential acquisitions, joint ventures and other initiatives, and may seek to expand our business through the acquisition of companies, processing plants, technologies, products and services. Acquisitions and joint ventures involve financial and operational risks and uncertainties, including:
challenges in realizing the anticipated benefits of the transaction;
difficulty integrating acquired businesses, technologies, operations and personnel with our existing business;
diversion of management attention in connection with negotiating transactions and integrating the businesses acquired;
difficulty identifying suitable candidates or consummating a transaction on terms that are favorable to us;
challenges in retaining the acquired businesses' customers and key employees;
inability to implement and maintain consistent standards, controls, procedures and information systems;
exposure to unforeseen or undisclosed liabilities of acquired companies; and
the need to obtain additional debt or equity financing for any transaction.
We may not be able to address these risks and successfully develop these acquired companies or businesses into profitable units. If we are unable to do this, such expansion could adversely affect our financial results.
Market fluctuations could negatively impact our operating results as we hedge certain transactions.
Our business is exposed to fluctuating market conditions. We use derivative financial instruments to reduce our exposure to various market risks including changes in commodity prices, interest rates and foreign exchange rates. We hold certain positions, primarily in grain and livestock futures, that do not qualify as hedges for financial reporting purposes. These positions are marked to fair value, and the unrealized gains and losses are reported in earnings at each reporting date. Therefore, losses on these contracts will adversely affect our reported operating results. While these contracts reduce our exposure to changes in prices for commodity products, the use of such instruments may ultimately limit our ability to benefit from favorable commodity prices.
Deterioration of economic conditions could negatively impact our business.
Our business may be adversely affected by changes in economic conditions, including inflation, interest rates, access to capital markets, consumer spending rates, energy availability and costs (including fuel surcharges) and the effects of governmental initiatives to manage economic conditions. Any such changes could adversely affect the demand for our products, or the cost and availability of our needed raw materials, cooking ingredients and packaging materials, thereby negatively affecting our financial results.
Disruptions in global credit and other financial markets and deterioration of economic conditions could, among other things:
make it more difficult or costly for us to obtain financing for our operations or investments or to refinance our debt in the future;
cause our lenders to depart from prior credit industry practice and make more difficult or expensive the granting of any amendment of, or waivers under, our credit agreements to the extent we may seek them in the future;
impair the financial condition of some of our customers and suppliers, thereby increasing customer bad debts or non-performance by suppliers;
negatively impact global demand for protein products, which could result in a reduction of sales, operating income and cash flows;
decrease the value of our investments in equity and debt securities, including our marketable debt securities, company-owned life insurance and pension and other postretirement plan assets;
negatively impact our commodity purchasing activities if we are required to record losses related to derivative financial instruments; or
impair the financial viability of our insurers.
The loss of one or more of our largest customers could negatively impact our business.
Our business could suffer significant setbacks in sales and operating income if our customers’ plans and/or markets change significantly or if we lost one or more of our largest customers, including, for example, Wal-Mart Stores, Inc., which accounted for 14.6% of our sales in fiscal 2014. Our retail customers typically do not enter into written contracts, and if they do sign contracts, they generally are limited in scope and duration. There can be no assurance that significant customers will continue to purchase our products in the same mix or quantities or on the same terms as in the past. Many of our customers, such as supermarkets, warehouse clubs and food distributors, have consolidated in recent years, and consolidation is expected to continue throughout the United States and in other major markets. These consolidations have produced large, sophisticated customers with increased buying power who are more capable of operating with reduced inventories, opposing price increases, and demanding lower pricing, increased promotional programs and specifically tailored products. These customers also may use shelf space currently used for our products for their own private label products. Because of these trends, our volume growth could slow or we may need to lower prices or increase promotional spending for our products. The loss of a significant customer or a material reduction in sales to, or adverse change to trade terms with, a significant customer could materially and adversely affect our product sales, financial condition and results of operations.

12



Extreme factors or forces beyond our control could negatively impact our business.
Our ability to make, move and sell products is critical to our success. Natural disasters, fire, bioterrorism, pandemic or extreme weather, including droughts, floods, excessive cold or heat, hurricanes or other storms, could impair the health or growth of livestock or interfere with our operations due to power outages, fuel shortages, damage to our production and processing facilities or disruption of transportation channels, among other things. Any of these factors could have an adverse effect on our financial results.
Failure to maximize or to successfully assert our intellectual property rights could impact our competitiveness.
We consider our intellectual property rights, particularly and most notably our trademarks, but also our trade secrets, patents and copyrights, to be a significant and valuable aspect of our business. We attempt to protect our intellectual property rights through a combination of trademark, trade secret, patent and copyright laws, as well as licensing agreements, third-party nondisclosure and assignment agreements and policing of third-party misuses of our intellectual property. We cannot be sure that these intellectual property rights will be maximized or that they can be successfully asserted. There is a risk that we will not be able to obtain and perfect our own or, where appropriate, license intellectual property rights necessary to support new product introductions. We cannot be sure that these rights, if obtained, will not be invalidated, circumvented or challenged in the future. In addition, even if such rights are obtained in the United States, the laws of some of the other countries in which our products are or may be sold do not protect our intellectual property rights to the same extent as the laws of the United States. Our failure to perfect or successfully assert our intellectual property rights could make us less competitive and could have an adverse effect on our business, operating results and financial condition.
Tyson Limited Partnership can exercise significant control.
As of September 27, 2014, Tyson Limited Partnership (the TLP) owns 99.985% of the outstanding shares of the Company's Class B Common Stock, $0.10 par value (Class B stock) and the TLP and members of the Tyson family own, in the aggregate, 1.78% of the outstanding shares of the Company's Class A Common Stock, $0.10 par value (Class A stock), giving them, collectively, control of approximately 70.14% of the total voting power of the Company's outstanding voting stock. At this time, the TLP does not have a managing general partner, as such, the management rights of the managing general partner may be exercised by a majority of the percentage interests of the general partners. As of September 27, 2014, Mr. John Tyson, Chairman of the Board of Directors, has 33.33% of the general partner percentage interests, and Ms. Barbara Tyson, a director of the Company, has 11.115% general partner percentage interests (the remaining general partnership interests are held by the Tyson Partnership Interest Trust (44.44%) and Harry C. Erwin, III (11.115%)). As a result of these holdings, positions and directorships, the partners in the TLP have the ability to exert substantial influence or actual control over our management and affairs and over substantially all matters requiring action by our stockholders, including amendments to our restated certificate of incorporation and by-laws, the election and removal of directors, any proposed merger, consolidation or sale of all or substantially all of our assets and other corporate transactions. This concentration of ownership may also delay or prevent a change in control otherwise favored by our other stockholders and could depress our stock price. Additionally, as a result of the TLP's significant ownership of our outstanding voting stock, we are eligible for “controlled company” exemptions from certain corporate governance requirements of the New York Stock Exchange.
We could incur substantial tax liabilities as a result of the DEMB Master Blenders 1753 N.V (“DEMB”) Spin-Off.
On June 28, 2012, Hillshire Brands divested its international coffee and tea business segment through the spin-off of DEMB (the “Spin-Off”). Hillshire Brands intended for the Spin-Off and certain related transactions to qualify as tax-free under Sections 355, 368(a)(1)(D), and 361 and related provisions of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code, which we refer to as the Code, and Hillshire Brands received a private letter ruling from the IRS substantially to the effect that the Spin-Off and certain related transactions, including the debt exchange, will qualify as tax-free to Hillshire Brands and its stockholders for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Although a private letter ruling generally is binding on the IRS, if the factual representations or assumptions made in the private letter ruling request are untrue or incomplete in any material respect, or any material forward-looking covenants or undertakings are not complied with, then Hillshire Brands would not be able to rely on the ruling. In addition, the ruling is based on current law, and cannot be relied upon if the applicable law changes with retroactive effect. As a matter of practice the IRS does not rule on every requirement for a tax-free spin-off or tax-free debt-for-debt exchange, and the parties relied solely on the opinion of counsel for comfort that such additional requirements should be satisfied. The opinion of counsel relies on, among other things, the continuing validity of the ruling and various assumptions and representations as to factual matters made by Hillshire Brands and DEMB which, if inaccurate or incomplete in any material respect, would jeopardize the conclusions reached by counsel in its opinion. The opinion is not binding on the IRS or the courts, and there can be no assurance that the IRS or the courts will not challenge the conclusions stated in the opinion or that any such challenge would not prevail. Accordingly, even though Hillshire Brands obtained a ruling and a “should” opinion of counsel, the IRS could assert that Hillshire Brands has not satisfied the requirements for tax-free treatment and such assertion, if successful, could result in significant U.S. federal income tax liabilities for us.

13



Events subsequent to the Spin-Off could cause the Spin-Off to become taxable. Under the terms of the tax sharing agreement Hillshire Brands entered into with DEMB in connection with the Spin-Off, DEMB will generally be required to indemnify Hillshire Brands for 100% of any taxes imposed on DEMB and its subsidiaries or Hillshire Brands and its subsidiaries in the event that the Spin-Off and certain related transactions were to fail to qualify for tax-free treatment as a result of an acquisition of DEMB (including the acquisition of DEMB by J.A. Benckiser), or actions or omissions (including breaches of certain representations and warranties made in the tax sharing agreement) by DEMB or any of its affiliates. However, if the Spin-Off or certain related transactions were to fail to qualify for tax-free treatment because of actions or omissions by Hillshire Brands or any of its affiliates, Hillshire Brands would be responsible for all such taxes. In addition, Hillshire Brands would be responsible for 50% of any taxes resulting from the failure of the Spin-Off and certain related transactions to qualify as tax-free, which failure is not due to actions or omissions (including breaches of certain representations and warranties made in the tax sharing agreement) by Hillshire Brands, DEMB or any of Hillshire Brands’ or DEMB's respective subsidiaries. There can be no assurance that the tax sharing agreement will be sufficient to protect Hillshire Brands against any tax liabilities that may arise, or that DEMB will be able to fully satisfy its indemnification obligations. Hillshire Brands’ inability to enforce the indemnification provisions of the tax sharing agreement or obtain indemnification payments in a timely manner could adversely affect our results of operations, cash flows and financial condition.
Multiemployer Pension Plan could adversely affect our business.
Through our wholly owned subsidiary, Hillshire Brands, we participate in a “multiemployer” pension plan administered by a labor union representing some of its employees. We are required to make periodic contributions to this plan to allow them to meet their pension benefit obligations to their participants. Our required contributions to this fund could increase because of a shrinking contribution base as a result of the insolvency or withdrawal of other companies that currently contribute to this fund, inability or failure of withdrawing companies to pay their withdrawal liability, lower than expected returns on pension fund assets or other funding deficiencies. In the event that we withdraw from participation in this plan, then applicable law could require us to make an additional lump-sum contribution to the plan, and we would have to reflect that as an expense in our consolidated statement of operations and as a liability on our consolidated balance sheet. Our withdrawal liability would depend on the extent of the plan's funding of vested benefits. The multiemployer plan in which we participate is reported to have significant underfunded liabilities. Such underfunding could increase the size of our potential withdrawal liability. In the event a withdrawal or partial withdrawal was to occur with respect to the multiemployer plan, the impact to our consolidated financial statements could be material.
Volatility in the capital markets or interest rates could adversely impact our pension costs and the funded status of our pension plans.
We sponsor a number of defined benefit plans for employees in the United States. The difference between plan obligations and assets, which signifies the funded status of the plans, is a significant factor in determining the net periodic benefit costs of the pension plans and our ongoing funding requirements. As of September 27, 2014, the funded status of our defined benefit pension plans was an underfunded position of $381 million, as compared to an underfunded position of $86 million at the end of fiscal 2013. The increase in the underfunded position is due to the acquisition of Hillshire Brands. Changes in interest rates and the market value of plan assets can impact the funded status of the plans and cause volatility in the net periodic benefit cost and our future funding requirements. The exact amount of cash contributions made to pension plans in any year is dependent upon a number of factors, including minimum funding requirements.
ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None.

14



ITEM 2. PROPERTIES
We have production and distribution operations in the following states: Alabama, Arizona, Arkansas, California, Delaware, Florida, Georgia, Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kansas, Kentucky, Mississippi, Maryland, Michigan, Missouri, Nebraska, New Mexico, New York, North Carolina, Oklahoma, Pennsylvania, South Carolina, Tennessee, Texas, Utah, Virginia, Washington and Wisconsin. We also have sales offices throughout the United States. Additionally, we, either directly or through our subsidiaries, have sales offices, facilities or participate in joint venture operations in Argentina, Brazil, Canada, China, the Dominican Republic, Hong Kong, India, Ireland, Japan, Mexico, the Netherlands, Peru, the Philippines, Russia, South Korea, Spain, Sri Lanka, Taiwan, Thailand, Turkey, the United Arab Emirates, the United Kingdom and Venezuela.
 
Number of Facilities
 
Owned

 
Leased

 
Total

Chicken Segment:
 
 
 
 
 
Processing plants
45

 
1

 
46

Rendering plants
9

 

 
9

Blending mills
2

 

 
2

Feed mills
32

 

 
32

Broiler hatcheries
59

 
3

 
62

Breeder houses
368

 

 
368

Broiler farm houses
48

 

 
48

Pet treats plant
1

 

 
1

Beef Segment Production Facilities
13

 

 
13

Pork Segment Production Facilities
9

 

 
9

Prepared Foods Segment:
 
 
 
 


Processing plants(1)
35

 
6

 
41

Hillshire Brands turkey operation facilities
6

 

 
6

Hillshire Brands distribution centers
5

 

 
5

International Segment:
 
 
 
 
 
Processing plants
9

 
2

 
11

Rendering plants
6

 

 
6

Feed mills
7

 
4

 
11

Broiler hatcheries
3

 
4

 
7

Breeder houses
159

 

 
159

Broiler farm houses
439

 

 
439

Distribution Centers
10

 
9

 
19

Cold Storage Facilities
60

 
14

 
74

Research and Development Facilities(2)
1

 
1

 
2

 
 
 
Capacity(3)
per week at
September 27, 2014

 
Fiscal 2014
Average Capacity
Utilization

Chicken Processing Plants
 
 
40 million head

 
90
%
Beef Production Facilities
 
 
173,000 head

 
77
%
Pork Production Facilities
 
 
445,000 head

 
86
%
Prepared Foods Processing Plants
 
 
85 million pounds

 
86
%
International Processing Plants
 
 
8 million head

 
67
%
(1) 
Includes 12 owned and four leased legacy Hillshire Brands processing plants. Additionally the 35 owned processing plants include three facilities, two legacy Prepared Foods (Buffalo, New York and Santa Teresa, New Mexico) and one legacy Hillshire Brands (Florence, Alabama), scheduled to close in fiscal 2015.
(2) 
Includes one leased facility outside Chicago, Illinois assumed in our acquisition of Hillshire Brands.
(3) 
Capacity per week based on the following: Chicken- five day week, Prepared Foods and International- five to six day week, Beef and Pork- six day week.

15



Chicken: Chicken processing plants include various phases of slaughtering, dressing, cutting, packaging, deboning and further-processing. We also have 30 animal nutrition operations, nine of which are associated with the Chicken rendering plants, 20 within various Chicken processing facilities and one pet treats plant. The blending mills, feed mills and broiler hatcheries have sufficient capacity to meet the needs of the chicken growout operations.
Beef: Beef plants include various phases of slaughtering live cattle and fabricating beef products. Some also treat and tan hides. The Beef segment includes three case-ready operations that share facilities with the Pork segment. One of the beef facilities contains a tallow refinery. Carcass facilities reduce live cattle to dressed carcass form. Processing facilities conduct fabricating operations to produce boxed beef and allied products.
Pork: Pork plants include various phases of slaughtering live hogs and fabricating pork products and allied products. The Pork segment includes three case-ready operations that share facilities with the Beef segment.
Prepared Foods: Prepared Foods plants process fresh and frozen chicken, turkey, beef, pork and other raw materials into pizza toppings, branded and processed meats, appetizers, prepared meals, ethnic foods, soups, sauces, side dishes, pizza crusts, flour and corn tortilla products and meat dishes.
International: International chicken processing plants include various phases of slaughtering, dressing, cutting, packaging, deboning and further-processing. The feed mills and broiler hatcheries generally have sufficient capacity to meet the needs of the chicken growout operations.
We believe our present facilities are generally adequate and suitable for our current purposes; however, seasonal fluctuations in inventories and production may occur as a reaction to market demands for certain products. We regularly engage in construction and other capital improvement projects intended to expand capacity and improve the efficiency of our processing and support facilities. We also consider the efficiencies of our operations and may from time to time consider changing the number or type of plants we operate to align with our capacity needs.
ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
Refer to the description of certain legal proceedings pending against us under Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 20: Commitments and Contingencies, which discussion is incorporated herein by reference. Listed below are certain additional legal proceedings involving the Company and/or its subsidiaries.
On June 17, 2014, the Missouri attorney general filed a civil lawsuit against us in the circuit court of Barry County, Missouri, concerning an incident that occurred in May 2014 in which some feed supplement was discharged from our plant in Monett, Missouri, to the City of Monett’s wastewater treatment plant allegedly leading to a fish kill in a local stream and odor issues around the plant. That lawsuit alleges six violations stemming from the incident and seeks penalties against us, compensation for damage to the stream, and reimbursement for the State of Missouri’s costs in investigating the matter. The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency has also indicated to us that it has begun a criminal investigation into the incident. If we become subject to criminal charges, we may be subject to a fine and other relief, as well as government contract suspension and debarment. We are cooperating with the Environmental Protection Agency but cannot predict the outcome of its investigation at this time. It is also possible that other regulatory agencies may commence investigations and allege additional violations. Finally, we may be subject to claims from the City of Monett for causing it to violate various municipal regulations and for damages to the City’s treatment system. We are currently in settlement discussions with the State of Missouri.
On June 19, 2005, the Attorney General and the Secretary of the Environment of the State of Oklahoma filed a complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of Oklahoma against Tyson Foods, Inc., three subsidiaries and six other poultry integrators. The complaint, which was subsequently amended, asserts a number of state and federal causes of action including, but not limited to, counts under Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act, Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, and state-law public nuisance theories. Oklahoma alleges that the defendants and certain contract growers who were not joined in the lawsuit polluted the surface waters, groundwater and associated drinking water supplies of the Illinois River Watershed through the land application of poultry litter. Oklahoma’s claims were narrowed through various rulings issued before and during trial and its claims for natural resource damages were dismissed by the district court in a ruling issued on July 22, 2009 which was subsequently affirmed on appeal by the Tenth Circuit Court of Appeals. A non-jury trial of the remaining claims including Oklahoma’s request for injunctive relief began on September 24, 2009. Closing arguments were held on February 11, 2010. The district court has not yet rendered its decision from the trial.
Other Matters: We currently have approximately 124,000 employees and, at any time, have various employment practices matters outstanding. In the aggregate, these matters are significant to the Company, and we devote significant resources to managing employment issues. Additionally, we are subject to other lawsuits, investigations and claims (some of which involve substantial amounts) arising out of the conduct of our business. While the ultimate results of these matters cannot be determined, they are not expected to have a material adverse effect on our consolidated results of operations or financial position.

16



ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
Not applicable.
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE COMPANY
Our executive officers serve one-year terms from the date of their election, or until their successors are appointed and qualified. No family relationships exist among these officers. The name, title, age and calendar year of initial election to executive office of our executive officers are listed below:
Name
 
Title
 
Age
 
Year Elected
Executive Officer
John Tyson
 
Chairman of the Board of Directors
 
61
 
2011
Curt T. Calaway
 
Senior Vice President, Controller and Chief Accounting Officer
 
41
 
2012
Andrew P. Callahan
 
President, Retail Packaged Brands
 
48
 
2014
Howell P. Carper
 
Executive Vice President, Strategy and New Ventures
 
61
 
2013
Sally Grimes
 
President and Global Growth Officer
 
43
 
2014
Thomas P. Hayes
 
President, Food Service
 
49
 
2014
Donnie King
 
President of North American Operations and Food Service
 
52
 
2009
Dennis Leatherby
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
 
54
 
1994
Mary Oleksiuk
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer
 
52
 
2014
Donnie Smith
 
President and Chief Executive Officer
 
55
 
2008
Stephen Stouffer
 
President, Fresh Meats
 
54
 
2013
David L. Van Bebber
 
Executive Vice President and General Counsel
 
58
 
2008
Noel White
 
President, Poultry
 
56
 
2009
John Tyson has served as Chairman of the Board of Directors since 1998 and was previously Chief Executive Officer of the Company from 2001 until 2006. Mr. Tyson was initially employed by the Company in 1973.
Curt T. Calaway was appointed Senior Vice President, Controller and Chief Accounting Officer in 2012, after serving as Vice President, Audit and Compliance since 2008, prior to which he served as the Company's Senior Director of Financial Reporting. Mr. Calaway was initially employed by the Company in 2006.
Andrew P. Callahan was appointed President, Retail Packaged Brands in September 2014. Mr. Callahan previously served as Executive Vice President and President, Retail of The Hillshire Brands Company, since 2012, prior to which he served as Senior Vice President, Chief Customer Officer for Sara Lee Corporation's North American operations from 2011 to 2012, after serving as President, of Sara Lee's North American Foodservice segment from 2009 to 2011. The Hillshire Brands Company was acquired by the Company in August 2014.
Howell P. (“Hal”) Carper was appointed Executive Vice President Strategy and New Ventures in 2013, after serving as Group Vice President, Research and Development, Logistics, and Technical Services since 2008, prior to which he served as Senior Vice President, Corporate Research and Development since 2003, and Senior Vice President and General Manager, Foodbrands Foodservice since 2001. Mr. Carper was appointed by IBP, inc. as Senior Vice President, Sales and Marketing in 1999. IBP, inc. was acquired by the Company in 2001. Prior to employment with IBP, inc., he served as Senior Vice President, Sales and Marketing with Foodbrands, Inc., which was acquired by IBP, inc. in 1997.
Sally Grimes was appointed President and Global Growth Officer in September 2014. Ms. Grimes previously served as Senior Vice President, Chief Innovation Officer and President, Gourmet Food Group, of The Hillshire Brands Company since 2012. Prior to joining Hillshire Brands, Ms. Grimes served as Global Vice President, Marketing, for the writing and creative expression business unit at Newell Rubbermaid, Inc. (global marketer of consumer and commercial products) from 2007 to 2012.
Thomas P. Hayes was appointed President, Food Service in September 2014. Mr. Hayes previously served as Executive Vice President and Chief Supply Chain Officer of The Hillshire Brands Company since 2012, prior to which he served as Senior Vice President and Chief Supply Chain Officer for Sara Lee Corporation's North American Retail and Foodservice businesses from 2009 to 2012. Mr. Hayes was initially employed by Sara Lee Corporation in 2006.

17



Donnie King was appointed President of North American Operations and Food Service in 2014, after serving as President of Prepared Foods, Customer and Consumer Solutions since 2013, Senior Group Vice President, Poultry and Prepared Foods since 2009, Group Vice President, Refrigerated and Deli since 2008, Group Vice President, Operations since 2007, Senior Vice President, Consumer Products Operations since 2006 and Senior Vice President, Poultry Operations since 2003. Mr. King was initially employed by Valmac Industries, Inc. in 1982. Valmac Industries, Inc. was acquired by the Company in 1984.
Dennis Leatherby was appointed Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer in 2008 after serving as Senior Vice President, Finance and Treasurer since 1998. He also served as Interim Chief Financial Officer from 2004 to 2006. Mr. Leatherby was initially employed by the Company in 1990.
Mary Oleksiuk was appointed Executive Vice President and Chief Human Resources Officer in September 2014. Ms. Oleksiuk previously served as Senior Vice President, Chief Human Resources Officer for The Hillshire Brands Company since 2012. Prior to joining Hillshire Brands, Ms. Oleksiuk served as Chief Human Resources Officer and Senior Vice President for Discover Financial Services from 2011 to 2012. From 2010 to 2011, she served as Senior Vice President, Global Human Resources with Alberto Culver Company and as Vice President, Global Human Resources with Alberto Culver Company from 2007 to 2010.
Donnie Smith was appointed President and Chief Executive Officer in 2009, after serving as Senior Group Vice President, Poultry and Prepared Foods since January 2009, prior to which he served as Group Vice President of Consumer Products since 2008, Group Vice President of Logistics and Operations Services since 2007, Group Vice President Information Systems, Purchasing and Distribution since 2006 and Senior Vice President and Chief Information Officer since 2005. Mr. Smith was initially employed by the Company in 1980.
Stephen R. Stouffer was appointed President, Fresh Meats in 2013, after serving as Senior Vice President, Beef Margin Management since 2012, prior to which he served as Vice President, Ground Beef, Trim and Variety Meats Sales since 2009, and Director, Ground Beef, Trim and Carcass Sales since 2006. Mr. Stouffer was initially employed by IBP, inc. in 1982.
David L. Van Bebber was appointed Executive Vice President and General Counsel in 2008, after serving as Senior Vice President and Deputy General Counsel since 2004. Mr. Van Bebber was initially employed by Lane Processing in 1982. Lane Processing was acquired by the Company in 1986.
Noel White was appointed President, Poultry in 2013, after serving as Senior Group Vice President, Fresh Meats since 2009, after serving as Senior Vice President, Pork Margin Management since 2007 and Group Vice President, Fresh Meats Operations/Commodity Sales since 2005. Mr. White was initially employed by IBP, inc. in 1983.

18



PART II
ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
We have issued and outstanding two classes of capital stock, Class A stock and Class B stock. Holders of Class B stock may convert such stock into Class A stock on a share-for-share basis. Holders of Class B stock are entitled to 10 votes per share and holders of Class A stock are entitled to one vote per share on matters submitted to shareholders for approval. As of October 25, 2014, there were approximately 24,000 holders of record of our Class A stock and seven holders of record of our Class B stock, excluding holders in the security position listings held by nominees.
DIVIDENDS
Cash dividends cannot be paid to holders of Class B stock unless they are simultaneously paid to holders of Class A stock. The per share amount of the cash dividend paid to holders of Class B stock cannot exceed 90% of the cash dividend simultaneously paid to holders of Class A stock. We have paid uninterrupted quarterly dividends on common stock each year since 1977. In fiscal 2014, the annual dividend rate for Class A stock was $0.30 per share and the annual dividend rate for Class B stock was $0.27 per share. In fiscal 2013, the annual dividend rate for Class A stock was $0.20 per share and the annual dividend rate for Class B stock was $0.18 per share. On November 13, 2014, the Board of Directors increased the quarterly dividend previously declared on July 30, 2014, to $0.10 per share on our Class A stock and $0.09 per share on our Class B stock. The increased quarterly dividend is payable on December 15, 2014, to shareholders of record at the close of business on December 1, 2014.
MARKET INFORMATION
Our Class A stock is traded on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “TSN.” No public trading market currently exists for our Class B stock. The high and low sales prices of our Class A stock for each quarter of fiscal 2014 and 2013 are represented in the table below.
 
2014
 
2013
 
High

 
Low

 
High

 
Low

First Quarter
$
34.38

 
$
27.33

 
$
19.91

 
$
15.93

Second Quarter
43.45

 
33.03

 
24.85

 
19.08

Third Quarter
44.24

 
34.90

 
26.00

 
22.47

Fourth Quarter
41.88

 
36.12

 
32.40

 
25.69

ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
The table below provides information regarding our purchases of Class A stock during the periods indicated.
Period
Total
Number of
Shares
Purchased

 
Average
Price Paid
per Share

Total Number of Shares
Purchased as Part of
Publicly Announced
Plans or Programs

 
Maximum Number of
Shares that May Yet Be
Purchased Under the Plans
or Programs (1)

Jun. 29, 2014 to Jul. 26, 2014
81,199

 
$
39.01


 
32,054,771

Jul. 27, 2014 to Aug. 30, 2014
107,377

 
38.41


 
32,054,771

Aug. 31, 2014 to Sept. 27, 2014
40,859

 
38.35


 
32,054,771

Total
229,435

(2) 
$
38.61


(3) 
32,054,771

(1) 
On February 7, 2003, we announced our Board of Directors approved a program to repurchase up to 25 million shares of Class A stock from time to time in open market or privately negotiated transactions. On May 3, 2012, our Board of Directors approved an increase of 35 million shares authorized for repurchase under this program. On January 30, 2014, our Board of Directors approved an increase of 25 million shares authorized for repurchase under this program. The program has no fixed or scheduled termination date.
(2) 
We purchased 229,435 shares during the period that were not made pursuant to our previously announced stock repurchase program, but were purchased to fund certain Company obligations under our equity compensation plans. These transactions included 176,258 shares purchased in open market transactions and 53,177 shares withheld to cover required tax withholdings on the vesting of restricted stock.
(3) 
There were no shares purchased during the period pursuant to our previously announced stock repurchase program.

19



PERFORMANCE GRAPH
The following graph shows a five-year comparison of cumulative total returns for our Class A stock, the Standard & Poor’s (S&P) 500 Index and a group of peer companies described below.
 
Fiscal Years Ending
 
Base Period
10/3/09

 
10/2/10

 
10/1/11

 
9/29/12

 
9/28/13

 
9/27/14

Tyson Foods, Inc.
$
100.00

 
$
133.34

 
$
143.66

 
$
133.73

 
$
242.06

 
$
322.02

S&P 500 Index
100.00

 
110.16

 
111.42

 
145.07

 
173.13

 
207.30

Previous Peer Group
100.00

 
114.42

 
120.23

 
136.08

 
150.45

 
169.01

Current Peer Group
100.00

 
115.87

 
123.31

 
145.13

 
179.48

 
200.67

The total cumulative return on investment (change in the year-end stock price plus reinvested dividends), which is based on the stock price or composite index at the end of fiscal 2009, is presented for each of the periods for the Company, the S&P 500 Index, the previous peer group and the current peer group. The previous peer group included: Archer-Daniels-Midland Company, Bunge Limited, Campbell Soup Company, ConAgra Foods, Inc., Dean Foods Company, General Mills, Inc., H.J. Heinz Co. (up to June 7, 2013), Hillshire Brands (beginning on June 28, 2012), Hormel Foods Corp., Kellogg Co., Kraft Foods Group Inc., McCormick & Co., Pilgrim’s Pride Corporation, Sanderson Farms, Inc., Smithfield Foods, Inc. (up to September 26, 2013) and The J.M. Smucker Company. The current peer group includes: Archer-Daniels-Midland Company, Bunge Limited, Campbell Soup Company, ConAgra Foods, Inc., Dean Foods Company, General Mills, Inc., Hillshire Brands (up to August 28, 2014), Hormel Foods Corp., Kellogg Co., Kraft Foods Group Inc., McCormick & Co., Mondelez Interenational Inc., Pilgrim's Pride Corporation, Sanderson Farms, Inc., and The J.M. Smucker Company. Hillshire Brands was removed from the current peer group at the time its shares ceased public trading. The differences between the current peer group and the previous peer group were the removal of H.J. Heinz Co. and Smithfield Foods, Inc. because both ceased being publicly traded companies in fiscal 2014, and the addition of Mondelez International, Inc. (formerly Kraft Foods, Inc.) to more accurately reflect the Company’s peers in terms of industry standing. The graph compares the performance of the Company with that of the S&P 500 Index and both peer groups, with the investment weighted on market capitalization.

20



ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
FIVE-YEAR FINANCIAL SUMMARY
in millions, except per share and ratio data
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2011

 
2010

Summary of Operations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
$
37,580

 
$
34,374

 
$
33,055

 
$
32,032

 
$
28,212

Operating income
1,430

 
1,375

 
1,286

 
1,289

 
1,574

Net interest expense
125

 
138

 
344

 
231

 
333

Income from continuing operations
856

 
848

 
614

 
738

 
783

Loss from discontinued operation, net of tax

 
(70
)
 
(38
)
 
(5
)
 
(18
)
Net income
856

 
778

 
576

 
733

 
765

Net income attributable to Tyson
864

 
778

 
583

 
750

 
780

Diluted net income per share attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income from continuing operations
2.37

 
2.31

 
1.68

 
1.98

 
2.09

Loss from discontinued operation

 
(0.19
)
 
(0.10
)
 
(0.01
)
 
(0.03
)
Net income
2.37

 
2.12

 
1.58

 
1.97

 
2.06

Dividends declared per share:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Class A
0.325

 
0.310

 
0.160

 
0.160

 
0.160

Class B
0.294

 
0.279

 
0.144

 
0.144

 
0.144

Balance Sheet Data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
438

 
$
1,145

 
$
1,071

 
$
716

 
$
978

Total assets
23,956

 
12,177

 
11,896

 
11,071

 
10,752

Total debt
8,178

 
2,408

 
2,432

 
2,182

 
2,536

Shareholders’ equity
8,904

 
6,233

 
6,042

 
5,685

 
5,201

Other Key Financial Measures
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation and amortization
$
530

 
$
519

 
$
499

 
$
506

 
$
497

Capital expenditures
632

 
558

 
690

 
643

 
550

EBITDA
1,897

 
1,818

 
1,731

 
1,767

 
1,987

Return on invested capital
11.8
%
 
18.5
%
 
17.7
%
 
18.5
%
 
23.0
%
Effective tax rate for continuing operations
31.6
%
 
32.6
%
 
36.4
%
 
31.6
%
 
35.9
%
Total debt to capitalization
47.9
%
 
27.9
%
 
28.7
%
 
27.7
%
 
32.8
%
Book value per share
$
23.70

 
$
18.13

 
$
16.84

 
$
15.38

 
$
13.78

Stock price high
44.24

 
32.40

 
21.06

 
20.12

 
20.57

Stock price low
27.33

 
15.93

 
14.07

 
14.59

 
11.91

Notes to Five-Year Financial Summary
a.
Fiscal 2014 included a $42 million pretax impairment charge and other costs related to the sale of our Brazil operation and Mexico's undistributed earnings tax, $197 million pretax expense related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition, integration and costs associated with our Prepared Foods improvement plan, $40 million pretax expense related to the Hillshire Brands post-closing results, purchase price accounting, and ongoing plant related legacy Hillshire Brands fire costs, $27 million pretax expense related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition financing incremental interest cost and $52 million unrecognized tax benefit gain.
b.
Fiscal 2013 included a $19 million currency translation adjustment gain recognized in conjunction with the receipt of proceeds constituting the final resolution of our investment in Canada.
c.
During fiscal 2013 we determined our Weifang operation (Weifang) was no longer core to the execution of our strategy in China. In July 2013, we completed the sale of Weifang. Non-cash charges related to the impairment of assets in Weifang amounted to $56 million and $15 million in fiscal 2013 and 2012, respectively.
d.
Fiscal 2012 included a pretax charge of $167 million related to the early extinguishment of debt.
e.
Fiscal 2011 included an $11 million non-operating gain related to the sale of interest in an equity method investment and a $21 million reduction to income tax expense related to a reversal of reserves for foreign uncertain tax positions.
f.
Fiscal 2010 included $61 million of interest expense related to losses on notes repurchased/redeemed during fiscal 2010, a $29 million non-tax deductible charge related to a full goodwill impairment related to an immaterial Chicken segment reporting unit and a $12 million non-operating charge related to the partial impairment of an equity method investment. Additionally, fiscal 2010 included insurance proceeds received of $38 million related to Hurricane Katrina.
g.
Return on invested capital is calculated by dividing operating income by the sum of the average of beginning and ending total debt and shareholders’ equity less cash and cash equivalents.
h.
For the total debt to capitalization calculation, capitalization is defined as total debt plus total shareholders’ equity.
i.
"EBITDA" is defined as net income less interest income, plus interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization.

21



EBITDA RECONCILIATIONS
A reconciliation of net income to EBITDA is as follows:
in millions, except ratio data
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2011

 
2010

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
856

 
$
778

 
$
576

 
$
733

 
$
765

Less: Interest income
(7
)
 
(7
)
 
(12
)
 
(11
)
 
(14
)
Add: Interest expense
132

 
145

 
356

 
242

 
347

Add: Income tax expense (a)
396

 
411

 
351

 
341

 
438

Add: Depreciation
494

 
474

 
443

 
433

 
416

Add: Amortization (b)
26

 
17

 
17

 
29

 
35

EBITDA
$
1,897

 
$
1,818

 
$
1,731

 
$
1,767

 
$
1,987

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total gross debt
$
8,178

 
$
2,408

 
$
2,432

 
$
2,182

 
$
2,536

Less: Cash and cash equivalents
(438
)
 
(1,145
)
 
(1,071
)
 
(716
)
 
(978
)
Less: Short-term investments
(1
)
 
(1
)
 
(3
)
 
(2
)
 
(2
)
Total net debt
$
7,739

 
$
1,262

 
$
1,358

 
$
1,464

 
$
1,556

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratio Calculations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross debt/EBITDA
4.3x

 
1.3x

 
1.4x

 
1.2x

 
1.3x

Net debt/EBITDA
4.1x

 
0.7x

 
0.8x

 
0.8x

 
0.8x

(a)
Includes income tax expense of discontinued operation.
(b)
Excludes the amortization of debt discount expense of $10 million, $28 million, $39 million, $44 million and $46 million for fiscal 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively, as it is included in Interest expense.
EBITDA represents net income, net of interest, income tax and depreciation and amortization. Net debt to EBITDA represents the ratio of our debt, net of cash and short-term investments, to EBITDA. EBITDA and net debt to EBITDA are presented as supplemental financial measurements in the evaluation of our business. We believe the presentation of these financial measures helps investors to assess our operating performance from period to period, including our ability to generate earnings sufficient to service our debt, and enhances understanding of our financial performance and highlights operational trends. These measures are widely used by investors and rating agencies in the valuation, comparison, rating and investment recommendations of companies; however, the measurements of EBITDA and net debt to EBITDA may not be comparable to those of other companies, which limits their usefulness as comparative measures. EBITDA and net debt to EBITDA are not measures required by or calculated in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) and should not be considered as substitutes for net income or any other measure of financial performance reported in accordance with GAAP or as a measure of operating cash flow or liquidity. EBITDA is a useful tool for assessing, but is not a reliable indicator of, our ability to generate cash to service our debt obligations because certain of the items added to net income to determine EBITDA involve outlays of cash. As a result, actual cash available to service our debt obligations will be different from EBITDA. Investors should rely primarily on our GAAP results, and use non-GAAP financial measures only supplementally, in making investment decisions.

22



ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
DESCRIPTION OF THE COMPANY
We are one of the world's largest producers of chicken, beef, pork and prepared foods that include leading brands such as Tyson®, Jimmy Dean®, Hillshire Farm®, Sara Lee® frozen bakery, Ball Park®, Wright®, Aidells® and State Fair®. Some of the key factors influencing our business are customer demand for our products; the ability to maintain and grow relationships with customers and introduce new and innovative products to the marketplace; accessibility of international markets; market prices for our products; the cost and availability of live cattle and hogs, raw materials, and feed ingredients; and operating efficiencies of our facilities.
Our operations are conducted in five segments: Chicken, Beef, Pork, Prepared Foods and International. Our International segment became a separate reportable segment in the second quarter of fiscal 2014 as a result of changes to our internal financial reporting to align with previously announced executive leadership changes. The International segment includes our foreign operations primarily related to raising and processing live chickens into fresh, frozen and value-added chicken products in Brazil, China, India and Mexico. All periods presented have been reclassified to reflect this change. Beef, Pork, Prepared Foods and Other results were not impacted by this change.
On August 28, 2014, we acquired and consolidated The Hillshire Brands Company ("Hillshire Brands"), a manufacturer and marketer of branded, convenient foods. Hillshire Brands' one month results from operations for fiscal 2014 are included in the Prepared Foods segment.
OVERVIEW
General – Operating income grew 4% in fiscal 2014 over fiscal 2013, which was led by record earnings in our Chicken segment and strong performance in our Beef and Pork segments. Revenues increased 9% to a record $37.6 billion, driven by price and mix improvements. We were able to overcome a $2.3 billion increase in input costs through strong operational execution and margin management. We continued to execute our strategy of accelerating growth in domestic value-added chicken sales, prepared food sales, innovating products, services and customer insights and cultivating our talent development to support Tyson's growth for the future.
Market environment – Our Chicken segment delivered record results in fiscal 2014 driven by strong demand and favorable domestic market conditions. Our Beef segment experienced higher fed cattle costs and reduced availability of fed cattle supplies but delivered strong results by maximizing our revenues relative to the rising costs experienced in the live cattle markets. The Pork segment's operating margins remained within its normalized range due to favorable market conditions associated with lower pork supplies. Our Prepared Foods segment was challenged by rapidly increasing raw material prices in addition to costs incurred as we continue to execute our Prepared Foods strategy. Our International segment experienced higher volumes, offset with lower average sales prices due to weak demand of chicken in our foreign operations.
Margins – Our total operating margin was 3.8% in fiscal 2014. Operating margins by segment were as follows:
Chicken – 7.9%     
Beef – 2.1%     
Pork – 7.2%
Prepared Foods – (1.5)%
International - (8.8)%
Liquidity – During fiscal 2014, we generated $1.2 billion of operating cash flows. We repurchased 7.1 million shares of our Class A common stock for $250 million under our share repurchase program in fiscal 2014. At September 27, 2014, we had $1.6 billion of liquidity, which includes the availability under our credit facility and $438 million of cash and cash equivalents.
Our accounting cycle resulted in a 52-week year for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012.

23



 
in millions, except per share data
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Net income from continuing operations attributable to Tyson
$
864

 
$
848

 
$
621

Net income from continuing operations attributable to Tyson – per diluted share
2.37

 
2.31

 
1.68

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net loss from discontinued operation attributable to Tyson

 
(70
)
 
(38
)
Net loss from discontinued operation attributable to Tyson – per diluted share

 
(0.19
)
 
(0.10
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income attributable to Tyson
864

 
778

 
583

Net income attributable to Tyson - per diluted share
2.37

 
2.12

 
1.58

2014 – Net income included the following items (fiscal 2014 per diluted share adjustments utilized a weighted average shares outstanding amount of 356 million):
$52 million, or $0.15 per diluted share, related to a gain from previously unrecognized tax benefits.
$197 million, or $0.37 per diluted share, related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition, integration and costs associated with our Prepared Foods improvement plan.
$42 million, or $0.16 per diluted share, related to an impairment in our Brazil operation and Mexico undistributed earnings tax.
$40 million, or $0.07 per diluted share, related to the Hillshire Brands post-closing results, purchase price accounting adjustments and ongoing costs related to a legacy Hillshire Brands plant fire.
$27 million, or $0.12 per diluted share, related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition financing incremental interest costs and share dilution.
2013 – Net income included the following item:
$19 million, or $0.05 per diluted share, related to recognized currency translation adjustment gain.
2012 – Net income included the following item:
$167 million pretax charge, or $0.29 per diluted share, related to the early extinguishment of debt.
SUMMARY OF RESULTS
Sales
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Sales
$
37,580

 
$
34,374

 
$
33,055

Change in sales volume
2.4
%
 
(0.2
)%
 
 
Change in average sales price
6.9
%
 
4.6
 %
 
 
Sales growth
9.3
%
 
4.0
 %
 
 
2014 vs. 2013 –
Sales Volume – Sales were positively impacted by an increase in sales volume, which accounted for an increase of $679 million. All segments, with the exception of the Beef segment, had an increase in sales volume. Prepared Foods contributed to the majority of the increase due to the acquisition and consolidation of Hillshire Brands in our final month of fiscal 2014.
Average Sales Price – Sales were positively impacted by higher average sales price, which accounted for an increase of approximately $2.5 billion. Beef, Pork and Prepared Foods experienced increased average sales price, partially offset by decreased pricing in Chicken and International. The increase in average sales price was largely due to continued tight domestic availability of protein, increased pricing associated with rising live and raw material costs, and improved mix. The majority of the increase was driven by the Beef and Pork segments.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Sales Volume – Sales were negatively impacted by a slight decrease in sales volume, which accounted for a decrease of $255 million. This was primarily due to decreases in the Beef and Pork segments, partially offset by increases in the Chicken, Prepared Foods and International segments.
Average Sales Price – Sales were positively impacted by higher average sales price, which accounted for an increase of approximately $1.6 billion. All segments experienced increased average sales price, largely due to continued tight domestic availability of protein, increased pricing associated with rising live and raw material costs, and improved mix. The majority of the increase was driven by the Chicken and Beef segments.

24



Cost of Sales
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Cost of sales
$
34,895

 
$
32,016

 
$
30,865

Gross profit
2,685

 
2,358

 
2,190

Cost of sales as a percentage of sales
92.9
%
 
93.1
%
 
93.4
%
2014 vs. 2013 –
Cost of sales increased by approximately $2.9 billion. Higher input costs per pound increased cost of sales $2.3 billion and higher sales volume increased cost of sales $610 million.
The $2.3 billion impact of higher input costs was primarily driven by:
Increase in live cattle and live hog costs of approximately $1.7 billion and $550 million, respectively.
Increase in raw material and other input costs in our Prepared Foods segment of approximately $210 million.
Increase due to net losses of $260 million in fiscal 2014, compared to net gains of approximately $5 million in fiscal 2013, from our Beef and Pork segment commodity risk management activities. These amounts exclude the impact from related physical purchase transactions, which mostly offset the losses.
Decrease in feed costs of $600 million in our Chicken segment and $42 million in our International segment.
The $610 million impact of higher sales volume was driven by increases in all of our segments, with the exception of Beef. Chicken and Prepared Foods contributed to the majority of the increase, with the Prepared Foods increase mainly attributable to the acquisition and consolidation of Hillshire Brands in our final month of fiscal 2014.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Cost of sales increased by approximately $1.2 billion due to higher input cost per pound.
The $1.2 billion impact of higher input costs was primarily driven by:
Increase in feed costs of $406 million in our Chicken segment and $64 million in our International segment.
Increase in live cattle and hog costs of approximately $395 million.
Increase in raw material and other input costs in our Prepared Foods segment of approximately $110 million.
Increase due to net losses of $15 million in fiscal 2013, compared to net gains of approximately $66 million in fiscal 2012, from our Pork segment commodity risk management activities. These amounts exclude the impact from related physical purchase transactions, which impact future period operating results.
Selling, General and Administrative
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Selling, general and administrative
$
1,255

 
$
983

 
$
904

As a percentage of sales
3.3
%
 
2.9
%
 
2.7
%
2014 vs. 2013 –
Increase of $272 million in selling, general and administrative was primarily driven by:
Increase of $71 million related to employee costs including payroll and stock-based and incentive-based compensation, of which $19 million related to employee severance and retention costs associated with the Hillshire Brands acquisition and implementation of our Prepared Foods strategy.
Increase of $32 million related to advertising and sales promotions.
Increase of $82 million related to professional fees, of which $52 million related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition and integration costs.
Increases of $17 million in information technology costs, $7 million in charitable contributions and donations and $5 million in commissions.
Increase of $50 million related to the Hillshire Brands selling, general and administrative post-closing expenses in our final month of fiscal 2014.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Increase of $79 million in selling, general and administrative was primarily driven by:
Increase of $44 million related to employee costs including payroll and stock-based and incentive-based compensation.
Increase of $32 million related to advertising and sales promotions.

25



Interest Income
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
$
(7
)
 
$
(7
)
 
$
(12
)
2014/2013/2012 – Interest income remained relatively flat due to continued low interest rates.
Interest Expense
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Cash interest expense, net of amounts capitalized
$
124

 
$
117

 
$
151

Loss on early extinguishment of debt

 

 
167

Non-cash interest expense
8

 
28

 
38

Total Interest Expense
$
132

 
$
145

 
$
356

2014/2013/2012 –
Cash interest expense primarily included interest expense related to the coupon rates for senior notes and term loans and commitment/letter of credit fees incurred on our revolving credit facilities. The increase in cash interest expense in fiscal 2014 was primarily due to senior notes and term loans issued and debt assumed in connection with our completed acquisition of Hillshire Brands on August 28, 2014, partially offset by lower cash interest expense on our 3.25% Convertible Senior Notes due 2013 (2013 Notes) which matured October 15, 2013. The decrease in cash interest expense in fiscal 2013 is due to lower average coupon rates compared to fiscal 2012. This decrease was driven by the full extinguishment of the 10.50% Senior Notes due 2014 (2014 Notes) in fiscal 2012, partially offset with the 4.5% Senior Notes due 2022 (2022 Notes) issued in fiscal 2012.
Loss on early extinguishment of debt included the amount paid exceeding the par value of debt, unamortized discount and unamortized debt issuance costs related to the full extinguishment of the 2014 Notes.
Non-cash interest expense primarily included interest related to the amortization of debt issuance costs and discounts/premiums on note issuances. This includes debt issuance costs incurred on our revolving credit facility, the senior notes and term loans issued in connection with our acquisition of Hillshire Brands and the accretion of the debt discount on the 2013 Notes. The decrease in non-cash interest expense in fiscal 2014 is due primarily to lower non-cash interest expense on our 2013 Notes.
Other (Income) Expense, net
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
$
53

 
$
(20
)
 
$
(23
)
2014 Included $60 million of costs associated with bridge financing facilities for the Hillshire Brands acquisition and $6 million of other than temporary impairment related to an available-for-sale security, partially offset with $14 million of equity earnings in joint ventures and net foreign currency exchange gains.
2013 Included $19 million related to recognized currency translation adjustment gain.
2012 Included $16 million of equity earnings in joint ventures and $4 million in net foreign currency exchange gains.

26



Effective Tax Rate
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
31.6
%
 
32.6
%
 
36.4
%
The effective tax rate on continuing operations was impacted by a number of items which result in a difference between our effective tax rate and the U.S. statutory rate of 35%. The table below reflects significant items impacting the rate as indicated.
2014 –
Domestic production activity deduction reduced the rate 4.0%.
Net decrease in unrecognized tax benefits, mostly related to expiration of statutes of limitations and settlements with taxing authorities, reduced the rate 4.7%.
State income taxes increased the rate 2.8%.
Foreign rate differences and valuation allowances increased the rate 2.8%.
2013 –
Domestic production activity deduction reduced the rate 3.2%.
General business credits reduced the rate 1.3%.
State income taxes increased the rate 2.4%.
2012 –
Domestic production activity deduction reduced the rate 1.8%.
General business credits reduced the rate 0.7%.
State income taxes increased the rate 1.5%.
Foreign rate differences and valuation allowances increased the rate 1.8%.
SEGMENT RESULTS
We operate in five segments: Chicken, Beef, Pork, Prepared Foods and International. The results from Dynamic Fuels are included in Other. We allocate expenses related to corporate activities to the segments, except for acquisition and integration related fees which are included in Other. The following table is a summary of sales and operating income (loss), which is how we measure segment income (loss).
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
Sales
 
Operating Income (Loss)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Chicken
$
11,116

 
$
10,988

 
$
10,270

 
$
883

 
$
683

 
$
554

Beef
16,177

 
14,400

 
13,755

 
347

 
296

 
218

Pork
6,304

 
5,408

 
5,510

 
455

 
332

 
417

Prepared Foods
3,927

 
3,322

 
3,237

 
(60
)
 
101

 
181

International
1,381

 
1,324

 
1,104

 
(121
)
 
(37
)
 
(70
)
Other

 
46

 
167

 
(74
)
 

 
(14
)
Intersegment Sales
(1,325
)
 
(1,114
)
 
(988
)
 

 

 

Total
$
37,580

 
$
34,374

 
$
33,055

 
$
1,430

 
$
1,375

 
$
1,286


27



Chicken Segment Results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

 
Change 2014
vs. 2013

 
2012

 
Change 2013
vs. 2012

Sales
$
11,116

 
$
10,988

 
$
128

 
$
10,270

 
$
718

Sales Volume Change
 
 
 
 
2.6
 %
 
 
 
0.7
%
Average Sales Price Change
 
 
 
 
(1.4
)%
 
 
 
6.2
%
Operating Income
$
883

 
$
683

 
$
200

 
$
554

 
$
129

Operating Margin
7.9
%
 
6.2
%
 
 
 
5.4
%
 
 
2014 vs. 2013 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume grew as a result of stronger demand for chicken products and mix of rendered product sales.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price decreased as feed ingredient costs declined, partially offset by mix changes.
Operating Income – Operating income increased due to higher sales volume and lower feed ingredient costs of $600 million, partially offset by decreased average sales price.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume grew due to increased production driven by stronger demand for our chicken products.
Average Sales Price – The increase in average sales price was primarily due to mix changes and price increases associated with higher input costs. Since many of our sales contracts are formula based or shorter-term in nature, we were able to offset rising input costs through improved pricing and mix.
Operating Income – Operating income was positively impacted by increased average sales price, and improved live performance and operational execution. These increases were partially offset by increased feed costs of $406 million.
Beef Segment Results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

 
Change 2014
vs. 2013

 
2012

 
Change 2013
vs. 2012

Sales
$
16,177

 
$
14,400

 
$
1,777

 
$
13,755

 
$
645

Sales Volume Change
 
 
 
 
(0.4
)%
 
 
 
(1.8
)%
Average Sales Price Change
 
 
 
 
12.8
 %
 
 
 
6.6
 %
Operating Income
$
347

 
$
296

 
$
51

 
$
218

 
$
78

Operating Margin
2.1
%
 
2.1
%
 
 
 
1.6
%
 
 
2014 vs. 2013 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume decreased due to a reduction in live cattle processed.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price increased due to lower domestic availability of beef products.
Operating Income – Operating income increased due to improved operational execution and maximizing our revenues relative to the rising live cattle markets, partially offset by increased operating costs.
Derivative Activities – Operating results included net losses of $72 million in fiscal 2014, compared to net gains of $9 million in fiscal 2013 for commodity risk management activities related to futures contracts. These amounts exclude the impact from related physical sale and purchase transactions, which mostly offset the commodity risk management gains and losses.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume decreased due to less outside trim and tallow purchases, partially offset by increased production volumes.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price increased due to lower domestic availability of fed cattle supplies, which drove up livestock costs.
Operating Income – Operating income increased due to improved operational execution, less volatile live cattle markets and improved export markets, partially offset by increased operating costs.

28



Pork Segment Results
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

 
Change 2014
vs. 2013

 
2012

 
Change 2013
vs. 2012

Sales
$
6,304

 
$
5,408

 
$
896

 
$
5,510

 
$
(102
)
Sales Volume Change
 
 
 
 
0.8
%
 
 
 
(3.6
)%
Average Sales Price Change
 
 
 
 
15.7
%
 
 
 
1.9
 %
Operating Income
$
455

 
$
332

 
$
123

 
$
417

 
$
(85
)
Operating Margin
7.2
%
 
6.1
%
 
 
 
7.6
%
 
 
2014 vs. 2013 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume increased due to better domestic demand for our pork products.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price increased due to lower total hog supplies, which resulted in higher input costs.
Operating Income – Operating income increased as we maximized our revenues relative to live hog markets, partially attributable to operational and mix performance.
Derivative Activities – Operating results included net losses of $112 million in fiscal 2014, compared to net losses of $15 million in fiscal 2013 for commodity risk management activities related to futures contracts. These amounts exclude the impact from related physical sale and purchase transactions, which mostly offset the commodity risk management losses.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume decreased as a result of decreased customer demand and reduced exports.
Average Sales Price – Demand for pork products improved, which drove up average sales price and livestock cost despite a slight increase in live hog supplies.
Operating Income – While reduced compared to prior year, operating income remained strong in fiscal 2013 despite brief periods of imbalance in industry supply and customer demand. We were able to maintain strong operating margins by maximizing our revenues relative to the live hog markets, partially due to operational and mix performance.
Derivative Activities – Operating results included net losses of $15 million in fiscal 2013, compared to net gains of $66 million in fiscal 2012 for commodity risk management activities related to futures contracts. These amounts exclude the impact from related physical sale and purchase transactions, which impact current and future period operating results.

29



Prepared Foods Segment Results
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
Change 2014
vs. 2013

 
2012

 
Change 2013
vs. 2012

Sales
$
3,927

 
$
3,322

 
$
605

 
$
3,237

 
$
85

Sales Volume Change
 
 
 
 
10.4
%
 
 
 
1.9
%
Average Sales Price Change
 
 
 
 
7.1
%
 
 
 
0.7
%
Operating Income
$
(60
)
 
$
101

 
$
(161
)
 
$
181

 
$
(80
)
Operating Margin
(1.5
)%
 
3.0
%
 
 
 
5.6
%
 
 
2014 vs. 2013 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume increased as a result of improved demand for our Prepared Foods products and incremental volumes as a result of the acquisition of Hillshire Brands in our final month of fiscal 2014.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price increased due to price increases associated with higher input costs along with better product mix which was positively impacted incrementally by the acquisition of Hillshire Brands in our final month of fiscal 2014.
Operating Income – Operating income decreased as a result of higher raw material and other input costs of approximately $210 million. Because many of our sales contracts are formula based or shorter-term in nature, we are typically able to offset rising input costs through pricing. However, there is a lag time for price increases to take effect. Additionally, operating income was reduced by $113 million due to additional costs associated with the Prepared Foods improvement plan, Hillshire Brands post-closing results, purchase price accounting adjustments and ongoing costs related to a legacy Hillshire Brands plant fire.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume increased as a result of improved demand for our prepared products and incremental volumes from the purchase of two businesses in fiscal 2013.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price increased due to price increases associated with higher input costs.
Operating Income – Operating income decreased, despite increases in sales volumes and average sales price, as a result of increased raw material and other input costs of approximately $110 million and additional costs incurred as we invested in our lunchmeat business and growth platforms. Because many of our sales contracts are formula based or shorter-term in nature, we are typically able to offset rising input costs through pricing. However, there is a lag time for price increases to take effect.
International Segment Results
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
Change 2014
vs. 2013

 
2012

 
Change 2013
vs. 2012

Sales
$
1,381

 
$
1,324

 
$
57

 
$
1,104

 
$
220

Sales Volume Change
 
 
 
 
12.2
 %
 
 
 
11.6
%
Average Sales Price Change
 
 
 
 
(7.0
)%
 
 
 
7.5
%
Operating Income (Loss)
$
(121
)
 
$
(37
)
 
$
(84
)
 
$
(70
)
 
$
33

Operating Margin
(8.8
)%
 
(2.8
)%
 
 
 
(6.3
)%
 
 
2014 vs. 2013 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume increased as we grew our businesses in Brazil and China.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price decreased due to poor export market conditions in Brazil, supply imbalances associated with weak demand in China and a less favorable pricing environment in Mexico.
Operating Income – Operating income decreased due to poor operational execution in Brazil, challenging market conditions in Brazil and China and additional costs incurred as we grew our International operation. Additionally, operating income was reduced by $42 million related to an impairment of Brazil assets and other costs related to the pending sale of our Brazil operation.
2013 vs. 2012 –
Sales Volume – Sales volume increased as we continued to grow our International operation.
Average Sales Price – Average sales price increased due to improved market conditions and more favorable pricing environments in Brazil and Mexico.
Operating Loss – Operating income improved due to better performance in Brazil and Mexico, partially offset by increased feed costs of $64 million and supply imbalances associated with weak demand in China as a result of avian influenza.

30



LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES
Our cash needs for working capital, capital expenditures, growth opportunities, the repurchases of senior notes, repayment of term loans and share repurchases are expected to be met with current cash on hand, cash flows provided by operating activities, or short-term borrowings. Based on our current expectations, we believe our liquidity and capital resources will be sufficient to operate our business. However, we may take advantage of opportunities to generate additional liquidity or refinance existing debt through capital market transactions. The amount, nature and timing of any capital market transactions will depend on our operating performance and other circumstances; our then-current commitments and obligations; the amount, nature and timing of our capital requirements; any limitations imposed by our current credit arrangements; and overall market conditions.
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
 
 
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Net income
$
856

 
$
778

 
$
576

Non-cash items in net income:
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation and amortization
530

 
519

 
499

Deferred income taxes
(105
)
 
(12
)
 
140

Convertible debt discount
(92
)
 

 

Loss on early extinguishment of debt

 

 
167

Impairment of assets
107

 
74

 
34

Other, net
31

 
26

 
18

Net changes in working capital
(149
)
 
(71
)
 
(247
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
$
1,178

 
$
1,314

 
$
1,187

Operating cash flows associated with the Convertible debt discount relates to the initial debt discount of $92 million on our 2013 Notes, which matured and were retired in fiscal 2014.
Operating cash flows associated with Loss on early extinguishment of debt included the amount paid exceeding the par value of debt, unamortized discount and unamortized debt issuance costs related to the full extinguishment of the 2014 Notes issued in 2009.
Cash flows associated with changes in working capital:
2014 – Decreased primarily due to the increase in inventory and accounts receivable balances and decrease in income taxes payable, partially offset by the increase in accounts payable. The higher inventory, accounts receivable and accounts payable balances are primarily attributable to significant increases in input costs and price increases associated with the increased input costs.
2013 – Decreased primarily due to a higher accounts receivable balance, partially offset by increases in accrued salaries, wages and benefits and income tax payable. The higher accounts receivable balance is largely due to significant increases in input costs and price increases associated with the increased input costs.
2012 – Decreased due to the increase in inventory and accounts receivable balances, partially offset by the increase in accounts payable. The higher inventory and accounts receivable balances were driven by significant increases in input costs and price increases associated with the increased input costs.

31



Cash Flows from Investing Activities
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Additions to property, plant and equipment
$
(632
)
 
$
(558
)
 
$
(690
)
Proceeds from sale/(Purchases) of marketable securities, net
15

 
(18
)
 
(11
)
Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
(8,193
)
 
(106
)
 

Other, net
10

 
39

 
41

Net cash used for investing activities
$
(8,800
)
 
$
(643
)
 
$
(660
)
Additions to property, plant and equipment include acquiring new equipment and upgrading our facilities to maintain competitive standing and position us for future opportunities.
Capital spending for fiscal 2015 is expected to approximate $900 million and will include spending on our operations for production and labor efficiencies, yield improvements and sales channel flexibility.
Acquisitions in fiscal 2014 related to acquiring Hillshire Brands and an additional value-added food business as part of our strategy to accelerate growth in our prepared foods sales. Both of these acquisitions are included in the Prepared Foods segment. For further description regarding these transactions refer to Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 3: Acquisitions and Dispositions.
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Payments on debt
$
(639
)
 
$
(91
)
 
$
(993
)
Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt
5,576

 
68

 
1,116

Proceeds from issuance of debt component of tangible equity units
205

 

 

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net of issuance costs
873

 

 

Net proceeds from issuance of equity component of tangible equity units
1,255

 

 

Purchases of Tyson Class A common stock
(295
)
 
(614
)
 
(264
)
Dividends
(104
)
 
(104
)
 
(57
)
Stock options exercised
67

 
123

 
34

Other, net
(23
)
 
18

 
(7
)
Net cash provided by (used for) financing activities
$
6,915

 
$
(600
)
 
$
(171
)
Payments on debt included –
2014 – Our 2013 Notes matured in fiscal 2014 at which time we paid the $458 million principal value with cash on hand and settled the conversion premium by issuing 11.7 million shares of our Class A stock from available treasury shares. The 2013 Notes were initially recorded at a $92 million discount, which equaled the fair value of an equity conversion premium instrument. The portion of the payment of the Notes related to the initial $92 million discount was recorded in cash flows from operating activities. Simultaneous to the settlement of the conversion premium, we received 11.7 million shares of our Class A stock from the call options.
2014 – $194 million related to the 5-year tranche A term loan facility and $30 million related to the 3-year tranche term loan facility.
2013 – $91 million primarily related to borrowings at our foreign subsidiaries.
2012 – $885 million for the extinguishment of the 2014 Notes and $103 million related to borrowings at our foreign subsidiaries.
Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt included –
2014 – $2,300 million from term loans and $3,243 million from senior unsecured notes after original issue discounts of $7 million. Additionally, total debt related to our foreign subsidiaries was $8 million at September 27, 2014, all of which is classified as long-term in our Consolidated Balance Sheets.
2013 – $68 million primarily from our foreign subsidiaries. Total debt related to our foreign subsidiaries was $60 million at September 28, 2013 ($40 million current, $20 million long-term).
2012 – We received net proceeds of $995 million from the issuance of the 2022 Notes. We used the net proceeds towards the extinguishment of the 2014 Notes, including the payments of accrued interest and related premiums, and general corporate purposes. Additionally, our foreign subsidiaries received proceeds of $115 million from borrowings. Total debt related to our foreign subsidiaries was $102 million at September 29, 2012 ($62 million current, $40 million long-term).

32



Proceeds from issuance of debt and equity components of tangible equity units –
2014 – We issued 30 million, 4.75% tangible equity units (TEUs). Total proceeds, net of underwriting discounts and other expenses, were $1,454 million. Each TEU is comprised of a prepaid stock purchase contract and a senior amortizing note due July 15, 2017. We allocated the proceeds from the issuance of the TEUs to equity and debt based on the relative fair values of the respective components of each TEU. The fair value of the prepaid stock purchase contracts, which was $1,295 million, is recorded in Capital in Excess of Par Value, net of $40 million issuance costs. The fair value of the senior amortizing notes, which was $205 million, is recorded in debt, of which $65 million is current.
Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net of issuance costs –
2014 – We issued 23.8 million shares of our Class A common stock, for total proceeds, net of underwriting discounts and other offering related fees and expenses, of $873 million.
Purchases of Tyson Class A common stock include –
$250 million, $550 million and $230 million for shares repurchased pursuant to our share repurchase program in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
$45 million, $64 million and $34 million for shares repurchased to fund certain obligations under our equity compensation plans in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
We currently do not plan to repurchase shares other than to fund obligations under equity compensation programs.
Liquidity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
 
Commitments
Expiration Date
 
Facility
Amount

 
Outstanding Letters of
Credit under Revolving
Credit Facility (no draw downs)

 
Amount
Borrowed

 
Amount
Available

Cash and cash equivalents
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
438

Short-term investments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1

Revolving credit facility
 
September 2019
 
$
1,250

 
$
41

 
$

 
1,209

Total liquidity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
1,648

The revolving credit facility supports our short-term funding needs and letters of credit. The letters of credit issued under this facility are primarily in support of workers’ compensation insurance programs and derivative activities.
Our 2013 Notes matured in October 2013. Upon maturity, we paid the $458 million principal value with cash on hand, and settled the conversion premium by issuing 11.7 million shares of our Class A stock from available treasury shares. Simultaneous to the settlement of the conversion premium, we received 11.7 million shares of our Class A stock from call options we entered into concurrently with the 2013 Note issuance.
We expect net interest expense will approximate $290 million for fiscal 2015 (53-weeks).
At September 27, 2014, approximately $380 million of our cash was held in the international accounts of our foreign subsidiaries. Generally, we do not rely on the foreign cash as a source of funds to support our ongoing domestic liquidity needs. Rather, we manage our worldwide cash requirements by reviewing available funds among our foreign subsidiaries and the cost effectiveness with which those funds can be accessed. The repatriation of cash balances from certain of our subsidiaries could have adverse tax consequences or be subject to regulatory capital requirements; however, those balances are generally available without legal restrictions to fund ordinary business operations. U.S. income taxes, net of applicable foreign tax credits, have not been provided on undistributed earnings of foreign subsidiaries with the exception of $17 million provided on the undistributed earnings of our Mexico and Brazil operations due to the pending sale of those operations. Except for cash generated from the sale of our Mexico and Brazil operations, our intention is to reinvest the cash held by foreign subsidiaries permanently or to repatriate the cash only when it is tax effective to do so.
Our current ratio was 1.64 to 1 and 1.86 to 1 at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively. The decrease in fiscal 2014 is due to the acquisition of Hillshire Brands.
Capital Resources
Credit Facility
Cash flows from operating activities and current cash on hand are our primary sources of liquidity for funding debt service, capital expenditures, dividends and share repurchases. We also have a revolving credit facility, with a committed capacity of $1.25 billion, to provide additional liquidity for working capital needs, letters of credit and a source of financing for growth opportunities. As of September 27, 2014, we had outstanding letters of credit totaling $41 million issued under this facility, none of which were drawn upon, which left $1,209 million available for borrowing. Our revolving credit facility is funded by a syndicate of 42 banks, with commitments ranging from $0.3 million to $85 million per bank. The syndicate includes bank holding companies that are required to be adequately capitalized under federal bank regulatory agency requirements.

33



Capitalization
To monitor our credit ratings and our capacity for long-term financing, we consider various qualitative and quantitative factors. We monitor the ratio of our net debt to EBITDA as support for our long-term financing decisions. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, the ratio of our net debt to EBITDA was 4.1x and 0.7x, respectively. Refer to Part II, Item 6, Selected Financial Data, for an explanation and reconciliation to comparable GAAP measures. The increase in this ratio for fiscal 2014 is due to the additional debt incurred related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition. As previously described, we incurred $2,300 million in term loans, $3,243 million in senior unsecured notes and $205 million in the debt component of tangible equity units. Additionally, as part of the transaction we assumed $868 million of senior notes and other debt from Hillshire Brands.
Credit Ratings
2016 Notes
On February 11, 2013, Standard & Poor's Ratings Services (S&P), upgraded the credit rating of the 2016 Notes from "BBB-" to "BBB." This upgrade did not impact the interest rate on the 2016 Notes.
On June 7, 2012, Moody's Investors Service, Inc. (Moody's) upgraded the credit rating of the 2016 Notes from "Ba1" to "Baa3." This upgrade decreased the interest rate on the 2016 Notes from 6.85% to 6.60%, effective beginning with the six-month interest payment due October 1, 2012.
A one-notch downgrade by Moody's would increase the interest rates on the 2016 Notes by 0.25%. A two-notch downgrade from S&P would increase the interest rates on the 2016 Notes by 0.25%.
Revolving Credit Facility
S&P’s corporate credit rating for Tyson Foods, Inc. is "BBB." Moody’s senior, unsecured, subsidiary guaranteed long-term debt rating for Tyson Foods, Inc. is "Baa3." Fitch Ratings' (Fitch), issuer default rating for Tyson Foods, Inc. is "BBB." The below table outlines the fees paid on the unused portion of the facility (Facility Fee Rate) and letter of credit fees (Undrawn Letter of Credit Fee and Borrowing Spread) depending on the rating levels of Tyson Foods, Inc. from S&P, Moody's and Fitch.
Ratings Level (S&P/Moody's/Fitch)
Facility Fee
Rate

Undrawn Letter of
Credit Fee and
Borrowing Spread

A-/A3/A- or above
0.100
%
1.000
%
BBB+/Baa1/BBB+
0.125
%
1.125
%
BBB/Baa2/BBB (current level)
0.150
%
1.250
%
BBB-/Baa3/BBB-
0.200
%
1.500
%
BB+/Ba1/BB+ or lower
0.250
%
1.750
%
In the event the rating levels are split, the applicable fees and spread will be based upon the rating level in effect for two of the rating agencies, or, if all three rating agencies have different rating levels, the applicable fees and spread will be based upon the rating level that is between the rating levels of the other two rating agencies.
Debt Covenants
Our revolving credit facility contains affirmative and negative covenants that, among other things, may limit or restrict our ability to: create liens and encumbrances; incur debt; merge, dissolve, liquidate or consolidate; make acquisitions and investments; dispose of or transfer assets; change the nature of our business; engage in certain transactions with affiliates; and enter into hedging transactions, in each case, subject to certain qualifications and exceptions. In addition, we are required to maintain minimum interest expense coverage and maximum debt to capitalization ratios.
Our senior notes and term loans also contain affirmative and negative covenants that, among other things, may limit or restrict our ability to: create liens; engage in certain sale/leaseback transactions; and engage in certain consolidations, mergers and sales of assets.
We were in compliance with all debt covenants at September 27, 2014.

34



Pension Plans
As further described in Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 15: Pension and Other Postretirement Benefits, the funded status of our defined benefit pension plans is defined as the amount the projected benefit obligation exceeds the plan assets. The funded status of the plans is an underfunded position of $381 million at the end of fiscal 2014 as compared to an underfunded position of $86 million at the end of fiscal 2013. The increase in the underfunded position is due to the acquisition of Hillshire Brands.
We expect to contribute approximately $14 million of cash to our pension plans in 2015 as compared to approximately $9 million in 2014 and $8 million in 2013. The exact amount of cash contributions made to pension plans in any year is dependent upon a number of factors, including minimum funding requirements. As a result, the actual funding in 2015 may be different from the estimate.
OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS
We do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements material to our financial position or results of operations. The off-balance sheet arrangements we have are guarantees of debt of outside third parties, including leases and grower loans, and residual value guarantees covering certain operating leases for various types of equipment. See Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 20: Commitments and Contingencies for further discussion.

35



CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS
The following table summarizes our contractual obligations as of September 27, 2014:
 
 
 
in millions

 
Payments Due by Period
 
2015

 
2016-2017

 
2018-2019

 
2020 and thereafter

 
Total

Debt and capital lease obligations:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Principal payments (1)
$
644

 
$
1,944

 
$
1,864

 
$
3,710

 
$
8,162

Interest payments (2)
312

 
488

 
423

 
1,540

 
2,763

Guarantees (3)
33

 
33

 
31

 
27

 
124

Operating lease obligations (4)
107

 
136

 
69

 
104

 
416

Purchase obligations (5)
2,625

 
844

 
460

 
249

 
4,178

Capital expenditures (6)
525

 
114

 
11

 
11

 
661

Other long-term liabilities (7)

 

 

 

 
481

Total contractual commitments
$
4,246

 
$
3,559

 
$
2,858

 
$
5,641

 
$
16,785

(1) 
In the event of a default on payment, acceleration of the principal payments could occur.
(2) 
Interest payments include interest on all outstanding debt. Payments are estimated for variable rate and variable term debt based on effective rates at September 27, 2014, and expected payment dates.
(3) 
Amounts include guarantees of debt of outside third parties, which consist of leases and grower loans, all of which are substantially collateralized by the underlying assets, as well as residual value guarantees covering certain operating leases for various types of equipment. The amounts included are the maximum potential amount of future payments.
(4) 
Amounts include minimum lease payments under lease agreements.
(5) 
Amounts include agreements to purchase goods or services that are enforceable and legally binding and specify all significant terms, including: fixed or minimum quantities to be purchased; fixed, minimum or variable price provisions; and the approximate timing of the transaction. The purchase obligations amount included items, such as future purchase commitments for grains, livestock contracts and fixed grower fees that provide terms that meet the above criteria. For certain grain purchase commitments with a fixed quantity provision, we have assumed the future obligations under the commitment based on available commodity futures prices as published in observable active markets as of September 27, 2014. We have excluded future purchase commitments for contracts that do not meet these criteria. Purchase orders are not included in the table, as a purchase order is an authorization to purchase and is cancelable. Contracts for goods or services that contain termination clauses without penalty have also been excluded.
(6) 
Amounts include estimated amounts to complete buildings and equipment under construction as of September 27, 2014.
(7) 
Other long-term liabilities primarily consist of deferred compensation, deferred income, self-insurance, and asset retirement obligations. We are unable to reliably estimate the amount of these payments beyond fiscal 2015; therefore, we have only included the total liability in the table above. We also have employee benefit obligations consisting of pensions and other postretirement benefits of $532 million that are excluded from the table above. A discussion of the company's pension and postretirement plans, including funding matters, is included in Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 15: Pensions and Other Postretirement Benefits.
In addition to the amounts shown above in the table, we have unrecognized tax benefits of $206 million and related interest and penalties of $54 million at September 27, 2014, recorded as liabilities.
The maximum contractual obligation associated with our cash flow assistance programs at September 27, 2014, based on the estimated fair values of the livestock supplier’s net tangible assets on that date, aggregated to approximately $330 million, or approximately $326 million remaining maximum commitment after netting the cash flow assistance related receivables.
RECENTLY ISSUED/ADOPTED ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS
Refer to the discussion under Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 1: Business and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies for recently issued accounting pronouncements and Note 2: Changes in Accounting Principles for recently adopted accounting pronouncements.

36



CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES
The preparation of consolidated financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions. These estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. The following is a summary of certain accounting estimates we consider critical.
 
Description
 
Judgments and Uncertainties
 
Effect if Actual Results Differ From
Assumptions
Contingent liabilities
 
 
 
 
We are subject to lawsuits, investigations and other claims related to wage and hour/labor, environmental, product, taxing authorities and other matters, and are required to assess the likelihood of any adverse judgments or outcomes to these matters, as well as potential ranges of probable losses.
 
A determination of the amount of reserves and disclosures required, if any, for these contingencies is made after considerable analysis of each individual issue. We accrue for contingent liabilities when an assessment of the risk of loss is probable and can be reasonably estimated. We disclose contingent liabilities when the risk of loss is reasonably possible or probable.
 
Our contingent liabilities contain uncertainties because the eventual outcome will result from future events, and determination of current reserves requires estimates and judgments related to future changes in facts and circumstances, differing interpretations of the law and assessments of the amount of damages, and the effectiveness of strategies or other factors beyond our control.
 
We have not made any material changes in the accounting methodology used to establish our contingent liabilities during the past three fiscal years.
 
We do not believe there is a reasonable likelihood there will be a material change in the estimates or assumptions used to calculate our contingent liabilities. However, if actual results are not consistent with our estimates or assumptions, we may be exposed to gains or losses that could be material.
 
 
 
 
 
Marketing and advertising costs
 
 
 
 
We incur advertising, retailer incentive and consumer incentive costs to promote products through marketing programs. These programs include cooperative advertising, volume discounts, in-store display incentives, coupons and other programs.
 
Marketing and advertising costs are charged in the period incurred. We accrue costs based on the estimated performance, historical utilization and redemption of each program.
 
Cash consideration given to customers is considered a reduction in the price of our products, thus recorded as a reduction to sales. The remainder of marketing and advertising costs is recorded as a selling, general and administrative expense.
 
Recognition of the costs related to these programs contains uncertainties due to judgment required in estimating the potential performance and redemption of each program.
 
These estimates are based on many factors, including experience of similar promotional programs.
 
We have not made any material changes in the accounting methodology used to establish our marketing accruals during the past three fiscal years.
 
We do not believe there is a reasonable likelihood there will be a material change in the estimates or assumptions used to calculate our marketing accruals. However, if actual results are not consistent with our estimates or assumptions, we may be exposed to gains or losses that could be material.
 
A 10% change in our marketing accruals at September 27, 2014, would impact pretax earnings by approximately $18 million.

37



Description
 
Judgments and Uncertainties
 
Effect if Actual Results Differ From
Assumptions
Accrued self-insurance
 
 
 
 
We are self-insured for certain losses related to health and welfare, workers’ compensation, auto liability and general liability claims.
 
We use an independent third-party actuary to assist in determining our self-insurance liability. We and the actuary consider a number of factors when estimating our self-insurance liability, including claims experience, demographic factors, severity factors and other actuarial assumptions.
 
We periodically review our estimates and assumptions with our third-party actuary to assist us in determining the adequacy of our self-insurance liability. Our policy is to maintain an accrual within the central to high point of the actuarial range.
 
Our self-insurance liability contains uncertainties due to assumptions required and judgment used.
 
Costs to settle our obligations, including legal and healthcare costs, could increase or decrease causing estimates of our self-insurance liability to change.
 
Incident rates, including frequency and severity, could increase or decrease causing estimates in our self-insurance liability to change.
 
We have not made any material changes in the accounting methodology used to establish our self-insurance liability during the past three fiscal years.
 
We do not believe there is a reasonable likelihood there will be a material change in the estimates or assumptions used to calculate our self-insurance liability. However, if actual results are not consistent with our estimates or assumptions, we may be exposed to gains or losses that could be material.
 
A 10% increase in the actuarial estimate at September 27, 2014, would result in an increase in the amount we recorded for our self-insurance liability of approximately $3 million. A 10% decrease in the actuarial estimate at September 27, 2014, would result in a decrease in the amount we recorded for our self-insurance liability of approximately $23 million.

38



Description
 
Judgments and Uncertainties
 
Effect if Actual Results Differ From
Assumptions
Defined benefit pension plans
 
 
 
 
We sponsor nine defined benefit pension plans that provide retirement benefits to certain employees. We also participate in a multi-employer plan that provides defined benefits to certain employees covered by collective bargaining agreements. Such plans are usually administered by a board of trustees composed of the management of the participating companies and labor representatives.

We use independent third-party actuaries to assist us in determining our pension obligations and net periodic benefit cost. We and the actuaries review assumptions that include estimates of the present value of the projected future pension payment to all plan participants, taking into consideration the likelihood of potential future events such as salary increases and demographic experience. We accumulate and amortize the effect of actuarial gains and losses over future periods.

Net periodic benefit costs for the defined benefit pension plans were $14 million in 2014. The projected benefit obligation was $2,031 million at the end of fiscal 2014. Unrecognized actuarial losses were $75 million at the end of fiscal 2014. We currently expect net periodic benefit cost for fiscal 2015 to be approximately $8 million.

Plan assets are currently comprised of approximately 81% fixed income securities and 12% equity securities. Fixed income securities can include, but are not limited to, direct bond investments and pooled or indirect bond investments. Other investments may include, but are not limited to, international and domestic equities, real estate, commodities and private equity.

We expect to contribute approximately $14 million of cash to our pension plans in fiscal 2015. The exact amount of cash contributions made to pension plans in any year is dependent upon a number of factors, including minimum funding requirements.

 
Our defined benefit pension plans contain uncertainties due to assumptions required and judgments used.

The key assumptions used in developing the required estimates include such factors as discount rates, expected returns on plan assets, retirement rates, and mortality.
These assumptions can have a material impact upon the funded status and the net periodic benefit cost.

The discount rates were determined using a cash flow matching technique whereby the rates of a yield curve, developed from high-quality debt securities, were applied to the benefit obligations to determine the appropriate discount rate. In determining the long-term rate of return on plan assets, we first examined historical rates of return for the various asset classes within the plans. We then determined a long-term projected rate-of-return based on expected returns. Investment, management and other fees paid out of plan assets are factored into the determination of asset return assumptions. Retirement rates are based primarily on actual plan experience, while standard actuarial tables are used to estimate mortality.

It is reasonably likely that changes in external factors will result in changes to the assumptions used to measure pension obligations and net periodic benefit cost in future periods.

The risks of participating in multiemployer plans are different from single-employer plans. The net pension cost of the multiemployer plans is equal to the annual contribution determined in accordance with the provisions of negotiated labor contracts. Assets contributed to such plans are not segregated or otherwise restricted to provide benefits only to our employees. The future cost of these plans is dependent on a number of factors including the funded status of the plans and the ability of the other participating companies to meet ongoing funding obligations.
 
We have not made any material changes in the accounting methodology used to establish our pension obligations and net periodic benefit cost during the past three fiscal years.

We do not believe there is a reasonable likelihood there will be a material change in the estimates or assumptions used to calculate our pension obligations and net periodic benefit cost. However, if actual results are not consistent with our estimates or assumptions, they are accumulated and amortized over future periods and, therefore generally affect the net periodic benefit cost in future periods.

A 1% increase in the discount rate at September 27, 2014, would result in an decrease in the projected benefit obligation and net periodic benefit cost of approximately $246 million and $2 million, respectively. A 1% decrease in the discount rate at September 27, 2014, would result in an increase in the projected benefit obligation and decrease in net periodic benefit cost of approximately $283 million and $1 million, respectively.

A 1% change in the return on plan assets at September 27, 2014, would impact the net periodic benefit cost by approximately $16 million.

The sensitivities reflect the impact of changing one assumption at a time and are specific to based conditions at the end of 2014. Economic factors and conditions often effect multiple assumption simultaneously and that the effect of changes in assumptions are not necessarily linear.


39



Description
 
Judgments and Uncertainties
 
Effect if Actual Results Differ From
Assumptions
Income taxes
 
 
 
 
We estimate total income tax expense based on statutory tax rates and tax planning opportunities available to us in various jurisdictions in which we earn income.

Federal income tax includes an estimate for taxes on earnings of foreign subsidiaries expected to be taxable upon remittance to the United States, except for earnings considered to be indefinitely invested in the foreign subsidiary.

Deferred income taxes are recognized for the future tax effects of temporary differences between financial and income tax reporting using tax rates in effect for the years in which the differences are expected to reverse.

Valuation allowances are recorded when it is likely a tax benefit will not be realized for a deferred tax asset.

We record unrecognized tax benefit liabilities for known or anticipated tax issues based on our analysis of whether, and the extent to which, additional taxes will be due.

 
Changes in tax laws and rates could affect recorded deferred tax assets and liabilities in the future.

Changes in projected future earnings could affect the recorded valuation allowances in the future.

Our calculations related to income taxes contain uncertainties due to judgment used to calculate tax liabilities in the application of complex tax regulations across the tax jurisdictions where we operate.

Our analysis of unrecognized tax benefits contains uncertainties based on judgment used to apply the more likely than not recognition and measurement thresholds.

 
We do not believe there is a reasonable likelihood there will be a material change in the tax related balances or valuation allowances. However, due to the complexity of some of these uncertainties, the ultimate resolution may result in a payment that is materially different from the current estimate of the tax liabilities.

To the extent we prevail in matters for which unrecognized tax benefit liabilities have been established, or are required to pay amounts in excess of our recorded unrecognized tax benefit liabilities, our effective tax rate in a given financial statement period could be materially affected. An unfavorable tax settlement would require use of our cash and generally result in an increase in our effective tax rate in the period of resolution. A favorable tax settlement would generally be recognized as a reduction in our effective tax rate in the period of resolution.

Impairment of long-lived assets
 
 
 
 
Long-lived assets are evaluated for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable. Examples include a significant adverse change in the extent or manner in which we use a long-lived asset or a change in its physical condition.
 
When evaluating long-lived assets for impairment, we compare the carrying value of the asset to the asset’s estimated undiscounted future cash flows. An impairment is indicated if the estimated future cash flows are less than the carrying value of the asset. For long-lived assets held for sale, we compare the carrying value of the disposal group to fair value. The impairment is the excess of the carrying value over the fair value of the long-lived asset.
 
We recorded impairment charges related to long-lived assets of $107 million, $74 million and $29 million, in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
 
Our impairment analysis contains uncertainties due to judgment in assumptions and estimates surrounding undiscounted future cash flows of the long-lived asset, including forecasting useful lives of assets and selecting the discount rate that reflects the risk inherent in future cash flows to determine fair value.


 
We have not made any material changes in the accounting methodology used to evaluate the impairment of long-lived assets during the last three fiscal years.
 
We do not believe there is a reasonable likelihood there will be a material change in the estimates or assumptions used to calculate impairments of long-lived assets. However, if actual results are not consistent with our estimates and assumptions used to calculate estimated future cash flows, we may be exposed to impairment losses that could be material.

Additionally, we continue to evaluate our domestic and international operations and strategies, which may expose us to future impairment losses.

  

40



Impairment of goodwill and other indefinite life intangible assets
Description: Goodwill is evaluated for impairment by first performing a qualitative assessment to determine whether a quantitative goodwill test is necessary. If it is determined, based on qualitative factors, the fair value of the reporting unit may be more likely than not less than carrying amount or if significant changes to macro-economic factors related to the reporting unit have occurred that could materially impact fair value, a quantitative goodwill impairment test would be required. We can elect to forgo the qualitative assessment and perform the quantitative test.
The quantitative goodwill impairment test is performed using a two-step process. The first step is to identify if a potential impairment exists by comparing the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered to have a potential impairment and the second step of the quantitative impairment test is not necessary. However, if the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step is performed to determine if goodwill is impaired and to measure the amount of impairment loss to recognize, if any.
The second step compares the implied fair value of goodwill with the carrying amount of goodwill. If the implied fair value of goodwill exceeds the carrying amount, then goodwill is not considered impaired. However, if the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds the implied fair value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill recognized in a business combination (i.e., the fair value of the reporting unit is allocated to all the assets and liabilities, including any unrecognized intangible assets, as if the reporting unit had been acquired in a business combination and the fair value of the reporting unit was determined as the exit price a market participant would pay for the same business).
For other indefinite life intangible assets, a qualitative assessment can also be performed to determine whether the existence of events and circumstances indicates it is more likely than not an intangible asset is impaired. Similar to goodwill, we can also elect to forgo the qualitative test for indefinite life intangible assets and perform the quantitative test. Upon performing the quantitative test, if the carrying value of the intangible asset exceeds its fair value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. We elected to forgo the qualitative assessments on our indefinite life intangible assets for the fiscal 2014 impairment test.
We have elected to make the first day of the fourth quarter the annual impairment assessment date for goodwill and other indefinite life intangible assets. However, we could be required to evaluate the recoverability of goodwill and other indefinite life intangible assets prior to the required annual assessment if, among other things, we experience disruptions to the business, unexpected significant declines in operating results, divestiture of a significant component of the business or a sustained decline in market capitalization.
Judgments and Uncertainties: We estimate the fair value of our reporting units, using various valuation techniques, with the primary technique being a discounted cash flow analysis, which uses significant unobservable inputs, or Level 3 inputs, as defined by the fair value hierarchy. A discounted cash flow analysis requires us to make various judgmental assumptions about sales, operating margins, growth rates and discount rates.
We include assumptions about sales, operating margins and growth rates which consider our budgets, business plans and economic projections, and are believed to reflect market participant views which would exist in an exit transaction. Assumptions are also made for varying perpetual growth rates for periods beyond the long-term business plan period. Generally, we utilize normalized operating margin assumptions based on future expectations and operating margins historically realized in the reporting units' industries.
Other indefinite life intangible asset fair values have been calculated for trademarks using a royalty rate method. Assumptions about royalty rates are based on the rates at which similar brands and trademarks are licensed in the marketplace.
Our impairment analysis contains uncertainties due to uncontrollable events that could positively or negatively impact the anticipated future economic and operating conditions.
Effect if Actual Results Differ From Assumptions: We have not made any material changes in the accounting methodology used to evaluate impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets during the last three years other than the adoption of the new guidance allowing the option to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is necessary to perform the two-step quantitative impairment test.
The discount rate used in our annual goodwill impairment test decreased to an average of 7.9% in fiscal 2014 from 8.4% in fiscal 2013. There were no significant changes in the other key estimates and assumptions.
During fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, all of our material reporting units that underwent a quantitative test passed the first step of the goodwill impairment analysis and therefore, the second step was not necessary.
Some of the inherent estimates and assumptions used in determining fair value of the reporting units are outside the control of management, including interest rates, cost of capital, tax rates and our credit ratings. While we believe we have made reasonable estimates and assumptions to calculate the fair value of the reporting units and other indefinite life intangible assets, it is possible a material change could occur. If our actual results are not consistent with our estimates and assumptions used to calculate fair value, we may be required to perform the second step, which could result in additional material impairments of our goodwill.

41



All of our material reporting units' estimated fair value exceeded their carrying value by more than 20% at the date of their most recent estimated fair value determination. Consequently, we do not currently consider any of our material reporting units at significant risk of failing the first step of the annual goodwill impairment test. At September 27, 2014, $4.8 billion of goodwill associated with our acquisition of Hillshire Brands has not yet been allocated to our reporting units. The allocation of this goodwill to our reporting units is pending finalization of the expected synergies and the impact of the synergies to our reporting units.
Our fiscal 2014 other indefinite life intangible asset impairment analysis did not result in an impairment charge. A hypothetical 20% decrease in the fair value of non-Hillshire Brands intangible assets would not result in a material impairment. We recorded $4.1 billion of indefinite life intangibles (brands and trademarks) associated with our acquisition of Hillshire Brands. Any significant decline in the estimated fair value of the Hillshire Brands indefinite life intangibles could result in a material impairment.
ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
Market risk relating to our operations results primarily from changes in commodity prices, interest rates and foreign exchange rates, as well as credit risk concentrations. To address certain of these risks, we enter into various derivative transactions as described below. If a derivative instrument is accounted for as a hedge, depending on the nature of the hedge, changes in the fair value of the instrument either will be offset against the change in fair value of the hedged assets, liabilities or firm commitments through earnings, or be recognized in other comprehensive income (loss) until the hedged item is recognized in earnings. The ineffective portion of an instrument’s change in fair value is recognized immediately. Additionally, we hold certain positions, primarily in grain and livestock futures that either do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting or are not designated as hedges. With the exception of normal purchases and normal sales that are expected to result in physical delivery, we record these positions at fair value, and the unrealized gains and losses are reported in earnings at each reporting date. Changes in market value of derivatives used in our risk management activities relating to forward sales contracts are recorded in sales. Changes in market value of derivatives used in our risk management activities surrounding inventories on hand or anticipated purchases of inventories are recorded in cost of sales.
The sensitivity analyses presented below are the measures of potential losses of fair value resulting from hypothetical changes in market prices related to commodities. Sensitivity analyses do not consider the actions we may take to mitigate our exposure to changes, nor do they consider the effects such hypothetical adverse changes may have on overall economic activity. Actual changes in market prices may differ from hypothetical changes.
Commodities Risk: We purchase certain commodities, such as grains and livestock in the course of normal operations. As part of our commodity risk management activities, we use derivative financial instruments, primarily futures and options, to reduce the effect of changing prices and as a mechanism to procure the underlying commodity. However, as the commodities underlying our derivative financial instruments can experience significant price fluctuations, any requirement to mark-to-market the positions that have not been designated or do not qualify as hedges could result in volatility in our results of operations. Contract terms of a hedge instrument closely mirror those of the hedged item providing a high degree of risk reduction and correlation. Contracts designated and highly effective at meeting this risk reduction and correlation criteria are recorded using hedge accounting. The following table presents a sensitivity analysis resulting from a hypothetical change of 10% in market prices as of September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, on the fair value of open positions. The fair value of such positions is a summation of the fair values calculated for each commodity by valuing each net position at quoted futures prices. The market risk exposure analysis includes hedge and non-hedge derivative financial instruments.
Effect of 10% change in fair value
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

Livestock:
 
 
 
Cattle
$
42

 
$
13

Hogs
32

 
35

Grain
10

 
23

Interest Rate Risk: At September 27, 2014, we had variable rate debt of $2.1 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 1.6%. A hypothetical 10% increase in interest rates effective at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, would have a minimal effect on interest expense.
Additionally, changes in interest rates impact the fair value of our fixed-rate debt. At September 27, 2014, we had fixed-rate debt of $6.1 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 4.3%. Market risk for fixed-rate debt is estimated as the potential increase in fair value, resulting from a hypothetical 10% decrease in interest rates. A hypothetical 10% decrease in interest rates would have increased the fair value of our fixed-rate debt by approximately $109 million at September 27, 2014, and $22 million at September 28, 2013. The fair values of our debt were estimated based on quoted market prices and/or published interest rates.

42



We have interest rate risk associated with our pension and post-retirement benefit obligations. Changes in interest rates impact the liabilities associated with these benefit plans as well as the amount of income or expense recognized for these plans. Declines in the value of the plan assets could diminish the funded status of the pension plans and potentially increase the requirements to make cash contributions to these plans. See Part II, Item 8, Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, Note 15: Pensions and Other Postretirement Benefits for additional information.
Foreign Currency Risk: We have foreign exchange exposure from fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates primarily as a result of certain receivable and payable balances. The primary currencies we have exposure to are the Brazilian real, the British pound sterling, the Canadian dollar, the Chinese renminbi, the European euro, the Indian rupee and the Mexican peso. We periodically enter into foreign exchange forward and option contracts to hedge some portion of our foreign currency exposure. A hypothetical 10% change in foreign exchange rates effective at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, related to the foreign exchange forward and option contracts would have a $9 million and $11 million impact, respectively, on pretax income.
Concentrations of Credit Risk: Our financial instruments exposed to concentrations of credit risk consist primarily of cash equivalents and trade receivables. Our cash equivalents are in high quality securities placed with major banks and financial institutions. Concentrations of credit risk with respect to receivables are limited due to our large number of customers and their dispersion across geographic areas. We perform periodic credit evaluations of our customers’ financial condition and generally do not require collateral. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, 18.6% and 17.5%, respectively, of our net accounts receivable balance was due from Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. No other single customer or customer group represented greater than 10% of net accounts receivable.

43



ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
TYSON FOODS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

 
Three years ended September 27, 2014
 
 
in millions, except per share data
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Sales
$
37,580

 
$
34,374

 
$
33,055

Cost of Sales
34,895

 
32,016

 
30,865

Gross Profit
2,685

 
2,358

 
2,190

Selling, General and Administrative
1,255

 
983

 
904

Operating Income
1,430

 
1,375

 
1,286

Other (Income) Expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income
(7
)
 
(7
)
 
(12
)
Interest expense
132

 
145

 
356

Other, net
53

 
(20
)
 
(23
)
Total Other (Income) Expense
178

 
118

 
321

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Taxes
1,252

 
1,257

 
965

Income Tax Expense
396

 
409

 
351

Income from Continuing Operations
856

 
848

 
614

Loss from Discontinued Operation, Net of Tax

 
(70
)
 
(38
)
Net Income
856

 
778

 
576

Less: Net Loss Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
(8
)
 

 
(7
)
Net Income Attributable to Tyson
$
864

 
$
778

 
$
583

Amounts Attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
Net Income from Continuing Operations
864

 
848

 
621

Net Loss from Discontinued Operation

 
(70
)
 
(38
)
Net Income Attributable to Tyson
$
864

 
$
778

 
$
583

Weighted Average Shares Outstanding:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
284

 
282

 
293

Class B Basic
70

 
70

 
70

Diluted
364

 
367

 
370

Net Income Per Share from Continuing Operations Attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
$
2.48

 
$
2.46

 
$
1.75

Class B Basic
$
2.26

 
$
2.22

 
$
1.57

Diluted
$
2.37

 
$
2.31

 
$
1.68

Net Loss Per Share from Discontinued Operation Attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
$

 
$
(0.20
)
 
$
(0.11
)
Class B Basic
$

 
$
(0.18
)
 
$
(0.09
)
Diluted
$

 
$
(0.19
)
 
$
(0.10
)
Net Income Per Share Attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
$
2.48

 
$
2.26

 
$
1.64

Class B Basic
$
2.26

 
$
2.04

 
$
1.48

Diluted
$
2.37

 
$
2.12

 
$
1.58

Dividends Declared Per Share:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A
$
0.325

 
$
0.310

 
$
0.160

Class B
$
0.294

 
$
0.279

 
$
0.144

See accompanying notes.

44



TYSON FOODS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

 
Three years ended September 27, 2014
 
 
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Net Income
$
856

 
$
778

 
$
576

Other Comprehensive Income (Loss), Net of Taxes:
 
 
 
 
 
Derivatives accounted for as cash flow hedges
1

 
(14
)
 
17

Investments
4

 
(3
)
 

Currency translation
(30
)
 
(37
)
 
3

Postretirement benefits
(14
)
 
9

 
(4
)
Total Other Comprehensive Income (Loss), Net of Taxes
(39
)
 
(45
)
 
16

Comprehensive Income
817

 
733

 
592

Less: Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
(8
)
 

 
(7
)
Comprehensive Income Attributable to Tyson
$
825

 
$
733

 
$
599

See accompanying notes.


45



TYSON FOODS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013
 
in millions, except share and per share data
 
 
2014

 
2013

Assets
 
 
 
Current Assets:
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
438

 
$
1,145

Accounts receivable, net
1,684

 
1,497

Inventories
3,274

 
2,817

Other current assets
379

 
145

Assets held for sale
446

 

Total Current Assets
6,221

 
5,604

Net Property, Plant and Equipment
5,130

 
4,053

Goodwill
6,706

 
1,902

Intangible Assets
5,276

 
138

Other Assets
623

 
480

Total Assets
$
23,956

 
$
12,177

Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
 
 
 
Current Liabilities:
 
 
 
Current debt
$
643

 
$
513

Accounts payable
1,806

 
1,359

Other current liabilities
1,207

 
1,138

Liabilities held for sale
141

 

Total Current Liabilities
3,797

 
3,010

Long-Term Debt
7,535

 
1,895

Deferred Income Taxes
2,450

 
479

Other Liabilities
1,270

 
560

Commitments and Contingencies (Note 20)


 

Shareholders’ Equity:
 
 
 
Common stock ($0.10 par value):
 
 
 
Class A-authorized 900 million shares, issued 346 million shares in 2014 and 322 million shares in 2013
35

 
32

Convertible Class B-authorized 900 million shares, issued 70 million shares
7

 
7

Capital in excess of par value
4,257

 
2,292

Retained earnings
5,748

 
4,999

Accumulated other comprehensive loss
(147
)
 
(108
)
Treasury stock, at cost – 40 million shares in 2014 and 48 million shares in 2013
(1,010
)
 
(1,021
)
Total Tyson Shareholders’ Equity
8,890

 
6,201

Noncontrolling Interests
14

 
32

Total Shareholders’ Equity
8,904

 
6,233

Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
$
23,956

 
$
12,177


See accompanying notes.

46



TYSON FOODS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
 
 
 
 
 
Three years ended September 27, 2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
Shares

 
Amount

 
Shares

 
Amount

 
Shares

 
Amount

Class A Common Stock:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
322

 
$
32

 
322

 
$
32

 
322

 
$
32

Issuance of Class A common stock
24

 
3

 

 

 

 

Balance at end of year
346

 
35

 
322

 
32

 
322

 
32

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Class B Common Stock:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning and end of year
70

 
7

 
70

 
7

 
70

 
7

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital in Excess of Par Value:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
2,292

 
 
 
2,278

 
 
 
2,261

Issuance of Class A common stock
 
 
870

 
 
 

 
 
 

Issuance of tangible equity units
 
 
1,255

 
 
 

 
 
 

Convertible debt settlement
 
 
(248
)
 
 
 

 
 
 

Convertible note hedge settlement
 
 
341

 
 
 

 
 
 

Warrant settlement
 
 
(289
)
 
 
 

 
 
 

Stock-based compensation
 
 
36

 
 
 
14

 
 
 
17

Balance at end of year
 
 
4,257

 
 
 
2,292

 
 
 
2,278

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Retained Earnings:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
4,999

 
 
 
4,327

 
 
 
3,801

Net income attributable to Tyson
 
 
864

 
 
 
778

 
 
 
583

Dividends
 
 
(115
)
 
 
 
(106
)
 
 
 
(57
)
Balance at end of year
 
 
5,748

 
 
 
4,999

 
 
 
4,327

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss), Net of Tax:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
(108
)
 
 
 
(63
)
 
 
 
(79
)
Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
 
 
(39
)
 
 
 
(45
)
 
 
 
16

Balance at end of year
 
 
(147
)
 
 
 
(108
)
 
 
 
(63
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Treasury Stock:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
48

 
(1,021
)
 
33

 
(569
)
 
22

 
(365
)
Purchase of Class A common stock
8

 
(295
)
 
24

 
(614
)
 
14

 
(264
)
Convertible debt settlement
(12
)
 
248

 

 

 

 

Convertible note hedge settlement
12

 
(341
)
 

 

 

 

Warrant settlement
(12
)
 
289

 

 

 

 

Stock-based compensation
(4
)
 
110

 
(9
)
 
162

 
(3
)
 
60

Balance at end of year
40

 
(1,010
)
 
48

 
(1,021
)
 
33

 
(569
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Shareholders’ Equity Attributable to Tyson
 
 
$
8,890

 
 
 
$
6,201

 
 
 
$
6,012

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at beginning of year
 
 
$
32

 
 
 
$
30

 
 
 
$
28

Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interests
 
 
(8
)
 
 
 

 
 
 
(7
)
Contributions by noncontrolling interest
 
 

 
 
 
3

 
 
 
9

Distributions to noncontrolling interest
 
 
(11
)
 
 
 

 
 
 

Net foreign currency translation adjustment and other
 
 
1

 
 
 
(1
)
 
 
 

Total Equity Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
 
 
$
14

 
 
 
$
32

 
 
 
$
30

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Shareholders’ Equity
 
 
$
8,904

 
 
 
$
6,233

 
 
 
$
6,042

See accompanying notes.

47



TYSON FOODS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
 
Three years ended September 27, 2014
 
 
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Cash Flows From Operating Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
856

 
$
778

 
$
576

Adjustments to reconcile net income to cash provided by operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation
494

 
474

 
443

Amortization
36

 
45

 
56

Deferred income taxes
(105
)
 
(12
)
 
140

Convertible debt discount
(92
)
 

 

Loss on early extinguishment of debt

 

 
167

Impairment of assets
107

 
74

 
34

Other, net
31

 
26

 
18

Increase in accounts receivable
(93
)
 
(126
)
 
(69
)
(Increase) decrease in inventories
(148
)
 
15

 
(259
)
Increase (decrease) in accounts payable
202

 
(12
)
 
106

Increase (decrease) in income taxes payable/receivable
(133
)
 
80

 
8

Increase (decrease) in interest payable
5

 
(1
)
 
5

Net changes in other working capital
18

 
(27
)
 
(38
)
Cash Provided by Operating Activities
1,178

 
1,314

 
1,187

Cash Flows From Investing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Additions to property, plant and equipment
(632
)
 
(558
)
 
(690
)
Purchases of marketable securities
(18
)
 
(135
)
 
(58
)
Proceeds from sale of marketable securities
33

 
117

 
47

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
(8,193
)
 
(106
)
 

Other, net
10

 
39

 
41

Cash Used for Investing Activities
(8,800
)
 
(643
)
 
(660
)
Cash Flows From Financing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Payments on debt
(639
)
 
(91
)
 
(993
)
Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt
5,576

 
68

 
1,116

Proceeds from issuance of debt component of tangible equity units
205

 

 

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net of issuance costs
873

 

 

Net proceeds from issuance of equity component of tangible equity units
1,255

 

 

Purchases of Tyson Class A common stock
(295
)
 
(614
)
 
(264
)
Dividends
(104
)
 
(104
)
 
(57
)
Stock options exercised
67

 
123

 
34

Other, net
(23
)
 
18

 
(7
)
Cash Provided by (Used for) Financing Activities
6,915

 
(600
)
 
(171
)
Effect of Exchange Rate Change on Cash

 
3

 
(1
)
Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents
(707
)
 
74

 
355

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Year
1,145

 
1,071

 
716

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Year
$
438

 
$
1,145

 
$
1,071

See accompanying notes.

48



NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
TYSON FOODS, INC.
NOTE 1: BUSINESS AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
Description of Business: Tyson Foods, Inc. (collectively, “Company,” “we,” “us” or “our”), founded in 1935 with world headquarters in Springdale, Arkansas, is one of the world's largest producers of chicken, beef, pork and prepared foods that include leading brands such as Tyson®, Jimmy Dean®, Hillshire Farm®, Sara Lee® frozen bakery, Ball Park®, Wright®, Aidells® and State Fair®.
Consolidation: The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of all wholly-owned subsidiaries, as well as majority-owned subsidiaries over which we exercise control and, when applicable, entities for which we have a controlling financial interest or variable interest entities for which we are the primary beneficiary. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.
Fiscal Year: We utilize a 52- or 53-week accounting period ending on the Saturday closest to September 30. The Company’s accounting cycle resulted in a 52-week year for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Cash and Cash Equivalents: Cash equivalents consist of investments in short-term, highly liquid securities having original maturities of three months or less, which are made as part of our cash management activity. The carrying values of these assets approximate their fair values. We primarily utilize a cash management system with a series of separate accounts consisting of lockbox accounts for receiving cash, concentration accounts where funds are moved to, and several zero-balance disbursement accounts for funding payroll, accounts payable, livestock procurement, grower payments, etc. As a result of our cash management system, checks issued, but not presented to the banks for payment, may result in negative book cash balances. These negative book cash balances are included in accounts payable and other current liabilities. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, checks outstanding in excess of related book cash balances totaled approximately $298 million and $246 million, respectively.
Accounts Receivable: We record accounts receivable at net realizable value. This value includes an appropriate allowance for estimated uncollectible accounts to reflect any loss anticipated on the accounts receivable balances and charged to the provision for doubtful accounts. We calculate this allowance based on our history of write-offs, level of past due accounts and relationships with and economic status of our customers. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, our allowance for uncollectible accounts was $34 million and $46 million, respectively. We generally do not have collateral for our receivables, but we do periodically evaluate the credit worthiness of our customers.
Inventories: Processed products, livestock and supplies and other are valued at the lower of cost or market. Cost includes purchased raw materials, live purchase costs, growout costs (primarily feed, grower pay and catch and haul costs), labor and manufacturing and production overhead, which are related to the purchase and production of inventories.
In fiscal 2014, 66% of the cost of inventories was determined by the first-in, first-out ("FIFO") method as compared to 58% in 2013. The remaining cost of inventories for both years is determined by the weighted-average method.
The following table reflects the major components of inventory at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013:
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

Processed products
$
1,794

 
$
1,423

Livestock
1,066

 
1,002

Supplies and other
414

 
392

Total inventory
$
3,274

 
$
2,817

Property, Plant and Equipment: Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost and generally depreciated on a straight-line method over the estimated lives for buildings and leasehold improvements of 10 to 33 years, machinery and equipment of three to 12 years and land improvements and other of three to 20 years. Major repairs and maintenance costs that significantly extend the useful life of the related assets are capitalized. Normal repairs and maintenance costs are charged to operations.
We review the carrying value of long-lived assets at each balance sheet date if indication of impairment exists. Recoverability is assessed using undiscounted cash flows based on historical results and current projections of earnings before interest and taxes. We measure impairment as the excess of carrying cost over the fair value of an asset. The fair value of an asset is measured using discounted cash flows including market participant assumptions of future operating results and discount rates.

49



Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets: Goodwill and indefinite life intangible assets are initially recorded at fair value and not amortized, but are reviewed for impairment at least annually or more frequently if impairment indicators arise. Our goodwill is allocated by reporting unit and is evaluated for impairment by first performing a qualitative assessment to determine whether a quantitative goodwill test is necessary. If it is determined, based on qualitative factors, the fair value of the reporting unit may be more likely than not less than carrying amount, or if significant changes to macro-economic factors related to the reporting unit have occurred that could materially impact fair value, a quantitative goodwill impairment test would be required. Additionally, we can elect to forgo the qualitative assessment and perform the quantitative test.
The first step of the quantitative test is to identify if a potential impairment exists by comparing the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered to have a potential impairment and the second step of the quantitative impairment test is not necessary. However, if the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step is performed to determine if goodwill is impaired and to measure the amount of impairment loss to recognize, if any. The second step compares the implied fair value of goodwill with the carrying amount of goodwill. If the implied fair value of goodwill exceeds the carrying amount, then goodwill is not considered impaired. However, if the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds the implied fair value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in the same manner as the amount of goodwill recognized in a business combination (i.e., the fair value of the reporting unit is allocated to all the assets and liabilities, including any unrecognized intangible assets, as if the reporting unit had been acquired in a business combination and the fair value of the reporting unit was determined as the exit price a market participant would pay for the same business). We have elected to make the first day of the fourth quarter the annual impairment assessment date for goodwill and other indefinite life intangible assets.
We estimate the fair value of our reporting units using a discounted cash flow analysis, which uses significant unobservable inputs, or Level 3 inputs, as defined by the fair value hierarchy. This analysis requires us to make various judgmental estimates and assumptions about sales, operating margins, growth rates and discount factors and is believed to reflect market participant views which would exist in an exit transaction. Generally, we utilize normalized operating margin assumptions based on future expectations and operating margins historically realized in the reporting units' industries. Some of the inherent estimates and assumptions used in determining fair value of the reporting units are outside the control of management, including interest rates, cost of capital, tax rates and credit ratings. While we believe we have made reasonable estimates and assumptions to calculate the fair value of the reporting units, it is possible a material change could occur. If our actual results are not consistent with our estimates and assumptions used to calculate fair value, we may be required to perform the second step of the quantitative test in future years, which could result in material impairments of our goodwill.
During fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, all of our material reporting units that underwent the quantitative test passed the first step of the goodwill impairment analysis and therefore, the second step was not necessary.
For our other indefinite life intangible assets, a qualitative assessment can also be performed to determine whether the existence of events and circumstances indicates it is more likely than not an intangible asset is impaired. Similar to goodwill, we can also elect to forgo the qualitative test for indefinite life intangible assets and perform the quantitative test. Upon performing the quantitative test, if the carrying value of the intangible asset exceeds its fair value, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
The fair value of our indefinite life intangible assets is calculated principally using relief-from-royalty and excess earnings valuation approaches and is believed to reflect market participant views which would exist in an exit transaction. Under these valuation approaches, we are required to make estimates and assumptions about sales, operating margins, growth rates, royalty rates and discount rates based on budgets, business plans, economic projections, anticipated future cash flows and marketplace data.
Investments: We have investments in joint ventures and other entities. We generally use the cost method of accounting when our voting interests are less than 20 percent. We use the equity method of accounting when our voting interests are in excess of 20 percent and we do not have a controlling interest or a variable interest in which we are the primary beneficiary. Investments in joint ventures and other entities are reported in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in Other Assets.
We also have investments in marketable debt securities. We have determined all of our marketable debt securities are available-for-sale investments. These investments are reported at fair value based on quoted market prices as of the balance sheet date, with unrealized gains and losses, net of tax, recorded in other comprehensive income. The amortized cost of debt securities is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts to maturity. Such amortization is recorded in interest income. The cost of securities sold is based on the specific identification method. Realized gains and losses on the sale of debt securities and declines in value judged to be other than temporary are recorded on a net basis in other income. Interest and dividends on securities classified as available-for-sale are recorded in interest income.
Accrued Self-Insurance: We use a combination of insurance and self-insurance mechanisms in an effort to mitigate the potential liabilities for health and welfare, workers’ compensation, auto liability and general liability risks. Liabilities associated with our risks retained are estimated, in part, by considering claims experience, demographic factors, severity factors and other actuarial assumptions.

50



Other Current Liabilities: Other current liabilities at September 27, 2014 and September 28, 2013, include:
 
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

Accrued salaries, wages and benefits
$
490

 
$
419

Other
717

 
719

Total other current liabilities
$
1,207

 
$
1,138

Defined Benefit Plans: We recognize the funded status of defined pension and postretirement plans in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. The funded status is measured as the difference between the fair value of the plan assets and the benefit obligation. We measure our plan assets and liabilities at the end of our fiscal year. For a defined benefit pension plan, the benefit obligation is the projected benefit obligation; for any other defined benefit postretirement plan, such as a retiree health care plan, the benefit obligation is the accumulated postretirement benefit obligation. Any overfunded status is recognized as an asset and any underfunded status is recognized as a liability. Any transitional asset/liability, prior service cost or actuarial gain/loss that has not yet been recognized as a component of net periodic cost is recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income. Accumulated other comprehensive income will be adjusted as these amounts are subsequently recognized as a component of net periodic benefit costs in future periods.
Financial Instruments: We purchase certain commodities, such as grains and livestock in the course of normal operations. As part of our commodity risk management activities, we use derivative financial instruments, primarily futures and options, to reduce our exposure to various market risks related to these purchases, as well as to changes in foreign currency exchange rates. Contract terms of a financial instrument qualifying as a hedge instrument closely mirror those of the hedged item, providing a high degree of risk reduction and correlation. Contracts designated and highly effective at meeting risk reduction and correlation criteria are recorded using hedge accounting. If a derivative instrument is accounted for as a hedge, changes in the fair value of the instrument will be offset either against the change in fair value of the hedged assets, liabilities or firm commitments through earnings or recognized in other comprehensive income (loss) until the hedged item is recognized in earnings. The ineffective portion of an instrument’s change in fair value is immediately recognized in earnings as a component of cost of sales. Instruments we hold as part of our risk management activities that do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting are marked to fair value with unrealized gains or losses reported currently in earnings. Changes in market value of derivatives used in our risk management activities relating to forward sales contracts are recorded in sales, while changes surrounding inventories on hand or anticipated purchases of inventories or supplies are recorded in cost of sales. We generally do not hedge anticipated transactions beyond 18 months.
Revenue Recognition: We recognize revenue when title and risk of loss are transferred to customers, which is generally on delivery based on terms of sale. Revenue is recognized as the net amount estimated to be received after deducting estimated amounts for discounts, trade allowances and product terms.
Litigation Reserves: There are a variety of legal proceedings pending or threatened against us. Accruals are recorded when it is probable a liability has been incurred and the amount of the liability can be reasonably estimated based on current law, progress of each case, opinions and views of legal counsel and other advisers, our experience in similar matters and intended response to the litigation. These amounts, which are not discounted and are exclusive of claims against third parties, are adjusted periodically as assessment efforts progress or additional information becomes available. We expense amounts for administering or litigating claims as incurred. Accruals for legal proceedings are included in Other current liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
Freight Expense: Freight expense associated with products shipped to customers is recognized in cost of sales.
Advertising and Promotion Expenses: Advertising and promotion expenses are charged to operations in the period incurred. Customer incentive and trade promotion activities are recorded as a reduction to sales based on amounts estimated as being due to customers, based primarily on historical utilization and redemption rates, while other advertising and promotional activities are recorded as selling, general and administrative expenses. Advertising and promotion expenses for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 were $641 million, $555 million and $496 million, respectively.
Research and Development: Research and development costs are expensed as incurred. Research and development costs totaled $52 million, $50 million and $43 million in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
Use of Estimates: The consolidated financial statements are prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, which require us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

51



Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements: In May 2014, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued guidance changing the criteria for recognizing revenue. The guidance also modifies the related disclosure requirements, clarifies guidance for multiple-element arrangements and provides guidance for transactions that were not addressed fully in previous guidance. The guidance is effective for annual reporting periods and interim periods within those annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2016, our fiscal 2018. Early adoption is not permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the impact this guidance will have on our consolidated financial statements.
NOTE 2: CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES
In December 2011 and February 2013, the FASB issued guidance enhancing disclosures related to offsetting of certain assets and liabilities. This guidance is effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after January 1, 2013, and interim periods within those annual periods. We adopted this guidance in the first quarter of fiscal 2014. The adoption did not have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements.
In April 2014, the FASB issued guidance changing the criteria for reporting discontinued operations. The guidance also modifies the related disclosure requirements. The guidance is effective on a prospective basis for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2014, and interim periods within annual periods beginning on or after December 15, 2015. Early adoption is permitted and we adopted it in the third quarter of fiscal 2014. The adoption did not have a significant impact on our consolidated financial statements.
NOTE 3: ACQUISITIONS AND DISPOSITIONS
Acquisitions
On August 28, 2014, we acquired all of the outstanding stock of The Hillshire Brands Company ("Hillshire Brands") as part of our strategic expansion initiative. The purchase price was equal to $63.00 per share for Hillshire Brands' outstanding common stock, or $8,081 million. In addition, we paid $163 million in cash for breakage costs incurred by Hillshire Brands related to a previously announced acquisition. We funded the acquisition with existing cash on hand, net proceeds from the issuance of new senior notes, Class A common stock (Class A stock), and tangible equity units as well as borrowings under a new term loan facility (refer to Note 7: Debt and Note 8: Equity). Hillshire Brands' results from operations subsequent to the acquisition closing are included in the Prepared Foods segment.
The following table summarizes the preliminary fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date. Certain estimated values for the acquisition, including goodwill, intangible assets, plant property and equipment, and deferred taxes, are not yet finalized and the preliminary purchase price allocations are subject to change as we complete our analysis of the fair value at the date of acquisition.
 
in millions
 
Cash and cash equivalents
 
$
72

Accounts receivable
 
236

Inventories
 
421

Other current assets
 
344

Property, Plant and Equipment
 
1,306

Goodwill
 
4,804

Intangible Assets
 
5,141

Other Assets
 
45

Accounts payable
 
(347
)
Other current liabilities
 
(324
)
Long-Term Debt
 
(868
)
Deferred Income Taxes
 
(2,069
)
Other Liabilities
 
(517
)
Net asset acquired
 
$
8,244


52



The fair value of identifiable intangible assets is as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

Intangible Asset Category
 
Type
 
Life in Years
 
Fair Value
Brands & trademarks
 
Non-amortizable
 
Indefinite
 
$
4,062

Brands & trademarks
 
Amortizable
 
20 years
 
532

Customer relationships
 
Amortizable
 
Weighted average life of 16 years
 
541

Non-compete agreements
 
Amortizable
 
1 year
 
6

Total identifiable intangible assets
 
 
 
 
 
$
5,141

As a result of the acquisition, we recognized a total of $4,804 million of goodwill. The purchase price was assigned to assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their estimated fair values as of the date of acquisition, and any excess was allocated to goodwill, as shown in the table above. Goodwill represents the value we expect to achieve through the implementation of operational synergies and growth opportunities primarily in our Prepared Foods segment. We do not expect the final fair value of goodwill to be deductible for U.S. income tax purposes.
We used various valuation techniques to determine fair value, with the primary techniques being discounted cash flow analysis, relief-from-royalty and excess earnings valuation approaches, which use significant unobservable inputs, or Level 3 inputs, as defined by the fair value hierarchy. Under these valuation approaches, we are required to make estimates and assumptions about sales, operating margins, growth rates, royalty rates and discount rates based on budgets, business plans, economic projections, anticipated future cash flows and marketplace data.
The acquisition of Hillshire Brands was accounted for using the acquisition method of accounting, and consequently, the results of operations for Hillshire Brands are reported in our consolidated financial statements from the date of acquisition. Hillshire Brands' one month results were insignificant to our Consolidated Statements of Income.
The following unaudited pro forma information presents the combined results of operations as if the acquisition of Hillshire Brands had occurred at the beginning of fiscal 2013. Hillshire Brands' pre-acquisition results have been added to our historical results. The pro forma results contained in the table below include adjustments for amortization of acquired intangibles, depreciation expense, interest expense related to the financing and related income taxes. Any potential cost savings or other operational efficiencies that could result from the acquisition are not included in these pro forma results.
The 2013 pro forma results include transaction related expenses incurred by Hillshire Brands prior to the acquisition of $168 million, including items such as consultant fees, accelerated stock compensation and other deal costs; transaction related expenses incurred by the Company of $115 million, including fees paid to third parties, financing costs and other deal costs; and $32 million expense related to the fair value inventory adjustment at the date of acquisition.
These pro forma results have been prepared for comparative purposes only and are not necessarily indicative of the results of operations as they would have been had the acquisitions occurred on the assumed dates, nor is it necessarily an indication of future operating results.
 
in millions  (unaudited)
 
 
2014

 
2013

Pro forma sales
$
41,311

 
$
38,195

Pro forma net income from continuing operations attributable to Tyson
1,047

 
655

Pro forma net income per diluted share from continuing operations attributable to Tyson
$
2.50

 
$
1.52

During the second quarter of fiscal 2014 we acquired a value-added food business as part of our strategic expansion initiative, which is included in our Prepared Foods segment. The aggregate purchase price of the acquisition was $56 million, which included $12 million for Property, Plant and Equipment, $27 million allocated to Intangible Assets and $18 million allocated to Goodwill.
During fiscal 2013, we acquired two value-added food businesses as part of our strategic expansion initiative, which are included in our Prepared Foods segment. The aggregate purchase price of the acquisitions was $106 million, which included $50 million for Property, Plant and Equipment, $41 million allocated to Intangible Assets and $12 million allocated to Goodwill.

53



Dispositions
On July 28, 2014, we announced our plan to sell our Brazil and Mexico operations, which are included in our International segment, to JBS SA ("JBS") for $575 million in cash. As a result, we conducted an impairment test and recorded a $39 million impairment charge in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2014 related to our Brazil operation. We expect to complete the sale of our Brazil operation in the first quarter of fiscal 2015. We expect to realize a gain on the sale of our Mexico operation, which is pending the necessary government approvals, and expect it to close in the first half of fiscal 2015. We have reclassified the assets and liabilities related to Mexico and Brazil to assets and liabilities held for sale in our 2014 Consolidated Balance Sheet.
The following table summarizes the net assets and liabilities held for sale:
 
in millions

 
2014

Assets held for sale:
 
Accounts receivable, net
$
74

Inventories
141

Other current assets
72

Net property, plant and equipment
132

Goodwill
16

Other assets
11

Total assets held for sale
$
446

Liabilities held for sale:
 
Current debt
$
32

Accounts payable
61

Other current liabilities
27

Long-term debt
9

Deferred income taxes
12

Total liabilities held for sale
$
141

In June 2014, we sold our 50 percent ownership interest of Dynamic Fuels LLC (Dynamic Fuels) for $30 million cash consideration at closing and up to $35 million in future cash payments contingent on Dynamic Fuels' production volumes over a period of up to 11.5 years. Additionally as part of the terms of the sale, we were released from our guarantee of the $100 million Gulf Opportunity Zone tax-exempt bonds, which were issued in October 2008 to fund a portion of the plant construction costs. Dynamic Fuels previously qualified as a variable interest entity which we consolidated, as we were the primary beneficiary. As a result of the sale, we deconsolidated Dynamic Fuels and recorded a gain of approximately $3 million, which is reflected in Cost of Sales in our Consolidated Statements of Income. We will recognize the future contingent payments in income as the required volumes are produced. At September 28, 2013, Dynamic Fuels had $166 million of total assets, of which $142 million was net property, plant and equipment, and $113 million of total liabilities, of which $100 million was long-term debt.
In fiscal 2014, we recorded impairment charges of $52 million related to the planned closure of three Prepared Foods plants. The Company’s Cherokee, Iowa plant closed in September 2014, while the Company’s plants in Buffalo, New York and Santa Teresa, New Mexico are expected to cease operations during the first half of calendar 2015. The impairment charges are reflected in the Consolidated Statements of Income in Cost of Sales. Additionally, in April 2014, Hillshire Brands announced that it will discontinue all production at its Florence, Alabama facility by December 30, 2014. The remaining closure costs are not expected to have a significant impact on the Company's financial results.

54



NOTE 4: DISCONTINUED OPERATION
After conducting an assessment during fiscal 2013 of our long-term business strategy in China, we determined our Weifang operation (Weifang), which was previously part of our Chicken segment, was no longer core to the execution of our strategy given the capital investment it required to execute our future business plan. Consequently, we conducted an impairment test and recorded a $56 million impairment charge in the second quarter of fiscal 2013. We subsequently sold Weifang which resulted in reporting it as a discontinued operation. The sale was completed in July 2013 and did not result in a significant gain or loss as its carrying value approximated the sales proceeds at the time of sale. Weifang's prior periods results, including the impairment charge, have been reclassified and presented as a discontinued operation in our Consolidated Statements of Income. The following is a summary of the discontinued operation's results:
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Sales
 
$

 
$
108

 
$
223

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Pretax loss
 

 
(68
)
 
(38
)
Income tax expense
 

 
2

 

Loss from discontinued operation, net of tax
 
$

 
$
(70
)
 
$
(38
)
NOTE 5: PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT
The following table reflects major categories of property, plant and equipment and accumulated depreciation at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013:
 
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

Land
$
126

 
$
100

Building and leasehold improvements
3,501

 
2,945

Machinery and equipment
6,144

 
5,504

Land improvements and other
276

 
417

Buildings and equipment under construction
334

 
236

 
10,381

 
9,202

Less accumulated depreciation
5,251

 
5,149

Net property, plant and equipment
$
5,130

 
$
4,053

Approximately $661 million will be required to complete buildings and equipment under construction at September 27, 2014.

55



NOTE 6: GOODWILL AND OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS
The following table reflects goodwill activity for fiscal 2014 and 2013:
in millions
 
 
Chicken

 
Beef

 
Pork

 
Prepared
Foods

 
International

 
Unallocated

 
Consolidated

Balance at September 29, 2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
$
909

 
$
1,123

 
$
317

 
$
63

 
$
68

 
$

 
$
2,480

Accumulated impairment losses

 
(560
)
 

 

 
(29
)
 

 
(589
)
 
909

 
563

 
317

 
63

 
39

 

 
1,891

Fiscal 2013 Activity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition

 

 

 
12

 

 

 
12

Impairment losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

Currency translation and other
(1
)
 

 

 

 

 

 
(1
)
Balance at September 28, 2013
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
908

 
1,123

 
317

 
75

 
68

 

 
2,491

Accumulated impairment losses

 
(560
)
 

 

 
(29
)
 

 
(589
)
 
$
908

 
$
563

 
$
317

 
$
75

 
$
39

 
$

 
$
1,902

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fiscal 2014 Activity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
18

 
$
5

 
$
4,804

 
$
4,827

Reclass to assets held for sale

 

 

 

 
(16
)
 

 
(16
)
Impairment losses

 

 

 

 
(5
)
 

 
(5
)
Currency translation and other
(1
)
 

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 
(2
)
Balance at September 27, 2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
907

 
1,123

 
317

 
92

 
57

 
4,804

 
7,300

Accumulated impairment losses

 
(560
)
 

 

 
(34
)
 

 
(594
)
 
$
907

 
$
563

 
$
317

 
$
92

 
$
23

 
$
4,804

 
$
6,706

On August 28, 2014, we acquired and consolidated Hillshire Brands. The unallocated portion of goodwill is attributable to our acquisition of Hillshire Brands. The allocation of goodwill to our reportable segments is pending finalization of the expected synergies and the impact of the synergies to our reporting units.

56



The following table reflects other intangible assets by type at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013:
in millions
 
 
2014

 
2013

Amortizable intangible assets:
 
 
 
Brands and trademarks
$
611

 
$
69

Customer relationships
570

 
12

Patents, intellectual property and other
136

 
140

Non-compete agreements
6

 

Land use rights
8

 
8

  Total gross amortizable intangible assets
$
1,331

 
$
229

     Less accumulated amortization
133

 
107

  Total net amortizable intangible assets
$
1,198

 
$
122

Brands and trademarks not subject to amortization
4,078

 
16

  Total intangible assets
$
5,276

 
$
138

Beginning with the date benefits are realized, amortizable intangible assets are generally amortized using the straight-line method over their estimated period of benefit of 20 years or less. Amortization expense of $26 million, $17 million and $16 million was recognized during fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. We estimate amortization expense on intangible assets for the next five fiscal years subsequent to September 27, 2014, will be: 2015 - $94 million; 2016 - $85 million; 2017 - $80 million; 2018 - $79 million; 2019 - $75 million.


57



NOTE 7: DEBT
The following table reflects major components of debt as of September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013:
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

Revolving credit facility
$

 
$

Senior notes:
 
 
 
3.25% Convertible senior notes due October 2013 (2013 Notes)

 
458

2.75% Senior notes due September 2015 (2015 Notes)
407

 

6.60% Senior notes due April 2016 (2016 Notes)
638

 
638

7.00% Notes due May 2018
120

 
120

2.65% Notes due August 2019 (2019 Notes)
1,000

 

4.10% Notes due September 2020 (2020 Notes)
287

 

4.50% Senior notes due June 2022 (2022 Notes)
1,000

 
1,000

3.95% Notes due August 2024 (2024 Notes)
1,250

 

7.00% Notes due January 2028
18

 
18

6.13% Notes due November 2032 (2032 Notes)
164

 

4.88% Notes due August 2034 (2034 Notes)
500

 

5.15% Notes due August 2044 (2044 Notes)
500

 

Discount on senior notes
(12
)
 
(6
)
Term loan facility:
 
 
 
3-year tranche
1,172

 

5-year tranche A
353

 

5-year tranche B
552

 

Amortizing Notes - Tangible Equity Units (see Note 8: Equity)
205

 

GO Zone tax-exempt bonds

 
100

Other
24

 
80

Total debt
8,178

 
2,408

Less current debt
643

 
513

Total long-term debt
$
7,535

 
$
1,895

Annual maturities of debt for the five fiscal years subsequent to September 27, 2014, are: 2015 - $644 million; 2016 - $885 million; 2017 - $1,059 million; 2018 - $176 million; 2019 - $1,688 million.
Revolving Credit Facility
In September 2014, we amended our existing credit facility which, among other things, increased our line of credit from $1.0 billion to $1.25 billion. The facility supports short-term funding needs and letters of credit and will mature with the commitments thereunder terminating in September 2019. After reducing the amount available by outstanding letters of credit issued under this facility, the amount available for borrowing at September 27, 2014, was $1,209 million. At September 27, 2014, we had outstanding letters of credit issued under this facility totaling $41 million, none of which were drawn upon. We had an additional $105 million of bilateral letters of credit issued separately from the revolving credit facility, none of which were drawn upon. Our letters of credit are issued primarily in support of workers’ compensation insurance programs and derivative activities.
The revolving credit facility is unsecured and is fully guaranteed by Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc. (TFM Parent), our wholly owned subsidiary, until such date TFM Parent is released from all of its guarantees of other material indebtedness. If in the future any of our other subsidiaries shall guarantee any of our material indebtedness, such subsidiary shall also be required to guarantee the indebtedness, obligations and liabilities under this facility.

58



2013 Notes
In September 2008, we issued $458 million principal amount 3.25% convertible senior unsecured notes due October 15, 2013. In connection with the issuance of the 2013 Notes, we entered into separate call option and warrant transactions with respect to our Class A stock to minimize the potential economic dilution upon conversion of the 2013 Notes. The call options contractually expired upon the maturity of the 2013 Notes. The 2013 Notes matured on October 15, 2013 at which time we paid the $458 million principal value with cash on hand and settled the conversion premium by issuing 11.7 million shares of our Class A stock from available treasury shares. Simultaneously with the settlement of the conversion premium, we received 11.7 million shares of our Class A stock from the call options.
The warrants were settled on various dates in fiscal 2014 resulting in the issuance of 11.7 million shares of Class A stock.
2016 Notes
The 2016 Notes carry an interest rate at issuance of 6.60%, with an interest step up feature dependent on their credit rating. On June 7, 2012, Moody's upgraded the credit rating of these notes from "Ba1" to "Baa3." This upgrade decreased the interest rate on the 2016 Notes from 6.85% to 6.60%, effective beginning with the six-month interest payment due October 1, 2012.
On February 11, 2013, S&P upgraded the credit rating of the 2016 Notes from "BBB-" to "BBB." This upgrade did not impact the interest rate on the 2016 Notes.
2019 / 2024 / 2034 / 2044 Notes
In August 2014, we issued senior unsecured notes with an aggregate principal amount of $3,250 million, consisting of $1,000 million due August 2019, $1,250 million due August 2024, $500 million due August 2034, and $500 million due August 2044. The 2019 Notes, 2024 Notes, 2034 Notes, and 2044 Notes carry interest rates of 2.65%, 3.95%, 4.88% and 5.15%, respectively, with interest payments due semi-annually on August 15 and February 15. After the original issue discounts of $7 million, we received net proceeds of $3,243 million. In addition, we incurred offering expenses of $27 million.
2022 Notes
In June 2012, we issued $1.0 billion of senior unsecured notes, which will mature in June 2022. The 2022 Notes carry a 4.50% interest rate, with interest payments due semi-annually on June 15 and December 15. After the original issue discount of $5 million, based on an issue price of 99.458%, we received net proceeds of $995 million. In addition, we incurred offering expenses of $9 million.
Term Loan Facility
In August 2014, we borrowed under our unsecured term loan facility, which provided for total term loans in an aggregate principal amount of $2,300 million, consisting of a $1,202 million 3-year tranche facility, a $546 million 5-year tranche A facility, and a $552 million 5-year tranche B facility. The principal of the 3-year tranche facility and the 5-year tranche A facility each amortize at 2.5% per quarter. In addition, we incurred term loan issuance costs of approximately $11 million.
2015 / 2020 / 2032 Notes
In August 2014 and in connection with our acquisition of Hillshire Brands, we assumed $840 million of Hillshire Brands' debt, which had an estimated fair value of approximately $868 million as of the acquisition date. We recorded the assumed debt at fair value. This fair value adjustment will be amortized as a reduction of interest expense in future periods. The debt assumed is mainly comprised of senior unsecured notes which consist of $400 million due September 2015, $278 million due September 2020, and $152 million due November 2032. The 2015 Notes, 2020 Notes, and the 2032 Notes carry interest rates of 2.75%, 4.10%, and 6.13%, respectively.
GO Zone Tax-Exempt Bonds
In October 2008, Dynamic Fuels received $100 million in proceeds from the sale of Gulf Opportunity Zone tax-exempt bonds made available by the federal government to the regions affected by Hurricanes Katrina and Rita in 2005. As further described in Note 3: Acquisitions and Dispositions, we sold our interest in Dynamic Fuels in fiscal 2014, which resulted in the deconsolidation of its assets and liabilities, including these bonds.
Debt Covenants
Our revolving credit facility contains affirmative and negative covenants that, among other things, may limit or restrict our ability to: create liens and encumbrances; incur debt; merge, dissolve, liquidate or consolidate; make acquisitions and investments; dispose of or transfer assets; change the nature of our business; engage in certain transactions with affiliates; and enter into hedging transactions, in each case, subject to certain qualifications and exceptions. In addition, we are required to maintain minimum interest expense coverage and maximum debt to capitalization ratios.
Our senior notes and term loans also contain affirmative and negative covenants that, among other things, may limit or restrict our ability to: create liens; engage in certain sale/leaseback transactions; and engage in certain consolidations, mergers and sales of assets.
We were in compliance with all debt covenants at September 27, 2014.

59



NOTE 8: EQUITY
Capital Stock
We have two classes of capital stock, Class A stock, $0.10 par value and Class B Common Stock, $0.10 par value (Class B stock). Holders of Class B stock may convert such stock into Class A stock on a share-for-share basis. Holders of Class B stock are entitled to 10 votes per share, while holders of Class A stock are entitled to one vote per share on matters submitted to shareholders for approval. As of September 27, 2014, Tyson Limited Partnership (the TLP) owned 99.985% of the outstanding shares of Class B stock and the TLP and members of the Tyson family owned, in the aggregate, 1.78% of the outstanding shares of Class A stock, giving them, collectively, control of approximately 70.14% of the total voting power of the outstanding voting stock.
The Class B stock is considered a participating security requiring the use of the two-class method for the computation of basic earnings per share. The two-class computation method for each period reflects the cash dividends paid for each class of stock, plus the amount of allocated undistributed earnings (losses) computed using the participation percentage, which reflects the dividend rights of each class of stock. Basic earnings per share were computed using the two-class method for all periods presented. The shares of Class B stock are considered to be participating convertible securities since the shares of Class B stock are convertible on a share-for-share basis into shares of Class A stock. Diluted earnings per share were computed assuming the conversion of the Class B shares into Class A shares as of the beginning of each period.
Dividends
Cash dividends cannot be paid to holders of Class B stock unless they are simultaneously paid to holders of Class A stock. The per share amount of the cash dividend paid to holders of Class B stock cannot exceed 90% of the cash dividend simultaneously paid to holders of Class A stock. We pay quarterly cash dividends to Class A and Class B shareholders. We paid Class A dividends per share of $0.30 and Class B dividends per share of $0.27 in fiscal 2014 and 2013, respectively. Fiscal 2013 included a special dividend of $0.10 per share for Class A stock and $0.09 per share for Class B. We paid Class A dividends per share of $0.16 and Class B dividends per share of $0.144 in fiscal 2012. On November 13, 2014, the Board of Directors increased the quarterly dividend previously declared on July 30, 2014, to $0.10 per share on our Class A stock and $0.09 per share on our Class B stock. The increased quarterly dividend is payable on December 15, 2014, to shareholders of record at the close of business on December 1, 2014.
Share Repurchases
On January 30, 2014, our Board of Directors approved an increase of 25 million shares authorized for repurchase under our share repurchase program. As of September 27, 2014, 32.1 million shares remained available for repurchase. The share repurchase program has no fixed or scheduled termination date and the timing and extent to which we repurchase shares will depend upon, among other things, our working capital needs, market conditions, liquidity targets, our debt obligations and regulatory requirements. In addition to the share repurchase program, we purchase shares on the open market to fund certain obligations under our equity compensation plans.
A summary of cumulative share repurchases of our Class A Stock is as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
 
September 27, 2014
 
September 28, 2013
 
September 29, 2012
 
 
Shares
 
Dollars
 
Shares
 
Dollars
 
Shares
 
Dollars
Shares repurchased:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Under share repurchase program
 
7.1

 
$
250

 
21.1

 
$
550

 
12.5

 
$
230

To fund certain obligations under equity compensation plans
 
1.2

 
45

 
2.8

 
64

 
1.8

 
34

Total share repurchases
 
8.3

 
$
295

 
23.9

 
$
614

 
14.3

 
$
264

Share Issuance
In fiscal 2014, we issued 23.8 million shares of our Class A stock, to provide funding for the Hillshire Brands acquisition. Total proceeds, net of underwriting discounts and other offering related fees and expenses were $873 million.

60



Tangible Equity Units
In July 2014, we completed the public issuance of 30 million, 4.75% tangible equity units (TEUs). Total proceeds, net of underwriting discounts and other expenses, were $1,454 million. Each TEU, which has a stated amount of $50, is comprised of a prepaid stock purchase contract and a senior amortizing note due July 15, 2017. We allocated the proceeds from the issuance of the TEUs to equity and debt based on the relative fair values of the respective components of each TEU. The fair value of the prepaid stock purchase contracts, which was $1,295 million, is recorded in Capital in Excess of Par Value, net of issuance costs. The fair value of the senior amortizing notes, which was $205 million, is recorded in debt, of which $65 million is current. Issuance costs associated with the TEU debt was recorded as deferred financing costs in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in Other Assets and is amortized over the term of the instrument to July 15, 2017.
The aggregate values assigned upon issuance of each component of the TEU's, based on the relative fair value of the respective components of each TEU, were as follows:
 
 
 
in millions, except price per TEU
 
 
Equity Component
 
Debt Component
 
Total
Price per TEU
$
43.17

 
$
6.83

 
$
50.00

Gross Proceeds
1,295

 
205

 
1,500

Issuance cost
(40
)
 
(6
)
 
(46
)
Net proceeds
$
1,255

 
$
199

 
$
1,454

Each senior amortizing note has an initial principal amount of $6.83 and bears interest at 1.5% per annum. On each January 15, April 15, July 15 and October 15, commencing on October 15, 2014, we will pay equal quarterly cash installments of $0.59 per amortizing note (except for the October 15, 2014 installment payment, which will be $0.46 per amortizing note), which cash payment in the aggregate (principal and interest) is equivalent to 4.75% per year with respect to the $50 stated amount per TEU. Each installment will constitute a payment of interest and partial repayment of principal. Unless settled earlier at the holder's or the Company's option, each purchase contract will automatically settle on July 15, 2017, subject to postponement in certain limited circumstances. We will deliver between a minimum of 31.7 million shares and a maximum of 39.7 million shares of our Class A stock, subject to adjustment, based upon the Applicable Market Value (as defined below) of our Class A stock as described below:
If the Applicable Market Value is equal to or greater than the conversion price of $47.25 per share, we will deliver 1.0582 shares of Class A stock per purchase contract, or a minimum of 31.7 million Class A shares.
If the Applicable Market Value is greater than the reference price of $37.80 but less than the conversion price of $47.25 per share, we will deliver a number of shares per purchase contract equal to $50, divided by the Applicable Market Value.
If the Applicable Market Value is less than or equal to the reference price of $37.80 per share, we will deliver 1.3228 shares of Class A stock per purchase contract, or a maximum of 39.7 million Class A shares.
The "Applicable Market Value" means the average of the closing prices of our Class A stock on each of the 20 consecutive trading days beginning on, and including, the 23rd scheduled trading day immediately preceding July 15, 2017.
The TEUs have a dilutive effect on our earnings per share. The 31.7 million minimum shares to be issued are included in the calculation of Class A Basic weighted average shares. The 8 million share difference between the minimum shares and the 39.7 million maximum shares are potentially dilutive securities, and accordingly, are included in our diluted earnings per share on a pro rata basis to the extent the Applicable Market Value is higher than the reference price but is less than the conversion price.

61



NOTE 9: INCOME TAXES
Detail of the provision for income taxes from continuing operations consists of the following:
 
 
 
 
 
in millions  

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Federal
$
325

 
$
341

 
$
310

State
67

 
38

 
22

Foreign
4

 
30

 
19

 
$
396

 
$
409

 
$
351

 
 
 
 
 
 
Current
$
501

 
$
421

 
$
211

Deferred
(105
)
 
(12
)
 
140

 
$
396

 
$
409

 
$
351

The reasons for the difference between the statutory federal income tax rate and our effective income tax rate from continuing operations are as follows:
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Federal income tax rate
35.0
 %
 
35.0
 %
 
35.0
 %
State income taxes
2.8

 
2.4

 
1.5

Unrecognized tax benefits, net
(4.7
)
 
(0.2
)
 
0.6

Domestic production deduction
(4.0
)
 
(3.2
)
 
(1.8
)
Foreign rate differences and valuation allowances
2.8

 
0.3

 
1.8

Other
(0.3
)
 
(1.7
)
 
(0.7
)
 
31.6
 %
 
32.6
 %
 
36.4
 %

During fiscal 2014, the domestic production deduction and the decrease in unrecognized tax benefits decreased tax expense by $50 million and $58 million, respectively.
During fiscal 2013, the domestic production deduction and estimated general business credits decreased tax expense by $40 million and $17 million, respectively.
During fiscal 2012, foreign valuation allowances increased tax expense by $10 million, and the domestic production deduction decreased tax expense by $17 million.
Approximately $18 million of loss and $53 million and $2 million of income from continuing operations before income taxes for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, were from operations based in countries other than the United States.
We recognize deferred income taxes for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled.

62



The tax effects of major items recorded as deferred tax assets and liabilities as of September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014
 
2013
 
Deferred Tax
 
Deferred Tax
 
Assets

 
Liabilities

 
Assets

 
Liabilities

Property, plant and equipment
$

 
$
732

 
$

 
$
525

Suspended taxes from conversion to accrual method

 
66

 

 
71

Intangible assets

 
2,031

 

 
29

Inventory
24

 
121

 
8

 
110

Accrued expenses
474

 

 
209

 

Net operating loss and other carryforwards
96

 

 
77

 

Insurance reserves
21

 

 
22

 

Other
80

 
82

 
60

 
98

 
$
695

 
$
3,032

 
$
376

 
$
833

Valuation allowance
$
(51
)
 
 
 
$
(77
)
 
 
Net deferred tax liability
 
 
$
2,388

 
 
 
$
534

We record deferred tax amounts in Other current assets, Other Assets, Other current liabilities and Deferred Income Taxes in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.
The deferred tax liability for suspended taxes from conversion to accrual method represents the 1987 change from the cash to accrual method of accounting and will be recognized by 2027.
The deferred tax liability for intangible assets increased over prior year due to the acquisition of Hillshire Brands.
At September 27, 2014, our gross state tax net operating loss carryforwards approximated $1.3 billion and expire in fiscal years 2015 through 2034. Gross foreign net operating loss carryforwards approximated $146 million, of which $50 million expire in fiscal years 2017 through 2024, and the remainder has no expiration. We also have tax credit carryforwards of approximately $25 million that expire in fiscal years 2015 through 2028.
We have accumulated undistributed earnings of foreign subsidiaries aggregating approximately $403 million and $351 million at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively. During fiscal 2014, the Company changed its permanent reinvestment assertion with respect to $183 million of earnings related to its poultry operations in Mexico and Brazil due to the planned sale of those operations and repatriation of the related proceeds, and as a result we recorded expense, net of foreign tax credits, of $17 million. With respect to the remaining $220 million of undistributed earnings for all other foreign subsidiaries at September 27, 2014, these earnings are expected to be indefinitely reinvested outside of the United States. If those earnings were distributed in the form of dividends or otherwise, we could be subject to federal income taxes (subject to an adjustment for foreign tax credits), state income taxes and withholding taxes payable to the various foreign countries. It is not currently practicable to estimate the tax liability that might be payable on the repatriation of these foreign earnings.
The following table summarizes the activity related to our gross unrecognized tax benefits at September 27, 2014September 28, 2013, and September 29, 2012:
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Balance as of the beginning of the year
$
175

 
$
168

 
$
174

Increases related to current year tax positions
11

 
3

 
3

Increases related to prior year tax positions
17

 
15

 
5

Increases related to Hillshire Brands balances
136

 

 

Reductions related to prior year tax positions
(20
)
 
(6
)
 
(10
)
Reductions related to settlements
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
(1
)
Reductions related to expirations of statute of limitations
(46
)
 
(3
)
 
(3
)
Balance as of the end of the year
$
272

 
$
175

 
$
168


63



The amount of unrecognized tax benefits, if recognized, that would impact our effective tax rate was $241 million and $149 million at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively. We classify interest and penalties on unrecognized tax benefits as income tax expense. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, before tax benefits, we had $54 million and $63 million, respectively, of accrued interest and penalties on unrecognized tax benefits.
As of September 27, 2014, we are subject to income tax examinations for U.S. federal income taxes for fiscal years 2011 through 2013. We are also subject to income tax examinations by major state and foreign jurisdictions for fiscal years 2005 through 2013 and 2002 through 2013, respectively. We estimate that during the next twelve months it is reasonably possible that unrecognized tax benefits could decrease by as much as $30 million primarily due to expiration of statutes in various jurisdictions.
NOTE 10: OTHER INCOME AND CHARGES
During fiscal 2014, we recorded $11 million of equity earnings in joint ventures, $3 million in net foreign currency exchange gains, $6 million of other than temporary impairment related to an available-for-sale security and $60 million of costs associated with bridge financing facilities for the Hillshire Brands acquisition, which were recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income in Other, net.
During fiscal 2013, we recorded a $19 million currency translation adjustment gain recognized in conjunction with the receipt of proceeds constituting the final resolution of our investment in Canada, which was recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income in Other, net.
During fiscal 2012, we recorded $16 million of equity earnings in joint ventures and $4 million in net foreign currency exchange gains, which were recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income in Other, net.

64



NOTE 11: EARNINGS PER SHARE
The earnings and weighted average common shares used in the computation of basic and diluted earnings per share are as follows:
 
in millions, except per share data
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Numerator:
 
 
 
 
 
Income from continuing operations
$
856

 
$
848

 
$
614

Less: Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interests
(8
)
 

 
(7
)
Net income from continuing operations attributable to Tyson
864

 
848

 
621

Less dividends declared:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A
94

 
87

 
47

Class B
21

 
19

 
10

Undistributed earnings
$
749

 
$
742

 
$
564

 
 
 
 
 
 
Class A undistributed earnings
$
612

 
$
606

 
$
464

Class B undistributed earnings
137

 
136

 
100

Total undistributed earnings
$
749

 
$
742

 
$
564

 
 
 
 
 
 
Denominator:
 
 
 
 
 
Denominator for basic earnings per share:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A weighted average shares
284

 
282

 
293

Class B weighted average shares, and shares under if-converted method for diluted earnings per share
70

 
70

 
70

Effect of dilutive securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Stock options and restricted stock
5

 
5

 
4

Tangible Equity Units
1

 

 

Convertible 2013 Notes

 
7

 
3

Warrants
4

 
3

 

Denominator for diluted earnings per share – adjusted weighted average shares and assumed conversions
364

 
367

 
370

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net Income Per Share from Continuing Operations Attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
$
2.48

 
$
2.46

 
$
1.75

Class B Basic
$
2.26

 
$
2.22

 
$
1.57

Diluted
$
2.37

 
$
2.31

 
$
1.68

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net Income Per Share Attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
$
2.48

 
$
2.26

 
$
1.64

Class B Basic
$
2.26

 
$
2.04

 
$
1.48

Diluted
$
2.37

 
$
2.12

 
$
1.58

We had approximately 4 million of our stock-based compensation shares that were antidilutive for fiscal 2014, no stock-based compensation shares that were antidilutive for fiscal 2013 and approximately 4 million of our stock-based compensation shares that were antidilutive for fiscal 2012. These shares were not included in the dilutive earnings per share calculation.
We have two classes of capital stock, Class A stock and Class B stock. Cash dividends cannot be paid to holders of Class B stock unless they are simultaneously paid to holders of Class A stock. The per share amount of cash dividends paid to holders of Class B stock cannot exceed 90% of the cash dividends paid to holders of Class A stock.
We allocate undistributed earnings based upon a 1 to 0.9 ratio per share to Class A stock and Class B stock, respectively. We allocate undistributed earnings based on this ratio due to historical dividend patterns, voting control of Class B shareholders and contractual limitations of dividends to Class B stock.

65



NOTE 12: DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
Our business operations give rise to certain market risk exposures mostly due to changes in commodity prices, foreign currency exchange rates and interest rates. We manage a portion of these risks through the use of derivative financial instruments, primarily futures and options, to reduce our exposure to commodity price risk, foreign currency risk and interest rate risk. Forwards on various commodities, including grains, livestock and energy, are primarily entered into to manage the price risk associated with forecasted purchases of these inputs used in our production processes. Foreign exchange forward contracts are entered into to manage the fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates, primarily as a result of certain receivable and payable balances. We also periodically utilize interest rate swaps to manage interest rate risk associated with our variable-rate borrowings.
Our risk management programs are periodically reviewed by our Board of Directors’ Audit Committee. These programs are monitored by senior management and may be revised as market conditions dictate. Our current risk management programs utilize industry-standard models that take into account the implicit cost of hedging. Risks associated with our market risks and those created by derivative instruments and the fair values are strictly monitored, using Value-at-Risk and stress tests. Credit risks associated with our derivative contracts are not significant as we minimize counterparty concentrations, utilize margin accounts or letters of credit, and deal with credit-worthy counterparties. Additionally, our derivative contracts are mostly short-term in duration and we generally do not make use of credit-risk-related contingent features. No significant concentrations of credit risk existed at September 27, 2014.
We recognize all derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities at fair value in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, with the exception of normal purchases and normal sales expected to result in physical delivery. The accounting for changes in the fair value (i.e., gains or losses) of a derivative instrument depends on whether it has been designated and qualifies as part of a hedging relationship and the type of hedging relationship. For those derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as hedging instruments, we designate the hedging instrument based upon the exposure being hedged (i.e., cash flow hedge or fair value hedge). We qualify, or designate, a derivative financial instrument as a hedge when contract terms closely mirror those of the hedged item, providing a high degree of risk reduction and correlation. If a derivative instrument is accounted for as a hedge, depending on the nature of the hedge, changes in the fair value of the instrument either will be offset against the change in fair value of the hedged assets, liabilities or firm commitments through earnings, or be recognized in other comprehensive income (loss) (OCI) until the hedged item is recognized in earnings. The ineffective portion of an instrument’s change in fair value is recognized in earnings immediately. We designate certain forward contracts as follows:
Cash Flow Hedges – include certain commodity forward and option contracts of forecasted purchases (i.e., grains) and certain foreign exchange forward contracts.
Fair Value Hedges – include certain commodity forward contracts of firm commitments (i.e., livestock).
Cash flow hedges
Derivative instruments, such as futures and options, are designated as hedges against changes in the amount of future cash flows related to procurement of certain commodities utilized in our production processes. We do not purchase forward and option commodity contracts in excess of our physical consumption requirements and generally do not hedge forecasted transactions beyond 18 months. The objective of these hedges is to reduce the variability of cash flows associated with the forecasted purchase of those commodities. For the derivative instruments we designate and qualify as a cash flow hedge, the effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative is reported as a component of OCI and reclassified into earnings in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affects earnings. Gains and losses representing hedge ineffectiveness are recognized in earnings in the current period. Ineffectiveness related to our cash flow hedges was not significant during fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012.
We had the following aggregated notional values of outstanding forward and option contracts accounted for as cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
in millions, except soy meal tons
 
 
 
Metric
 
September 27, 2014

 
September 28, 2013

Commodity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corn
 
Bushels
 

 
5

Soy Meal
 
Tons
 
2,300

 
96,800

Foreign Currency
 
United States dollar
 
$
1

 
$
60

As of September 27, 2014, the net amounts expected to be reclassified into earnings within the next 12 months are pretax losses of $4 million related to grain. During fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, we did not reclassify significant pretax gains/losses into earnings as a result of the discontinuance of cash flow hedges due to the probability the original forecasted transaction would not occur by the end of the originally specified time period or within the additional period of time allowed by generally accepted accounting principles.


66



The following table sets forth the pretax impact of cash flow hedge derivative instruments in the Consolidated Statements of Income:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
Gain/(Loss)
Recognized in OCI
on Derivatives
 
 
Consolidated
Statements of Income
Classification
 
Gain/(Loss)
Reclassified from
OCI to Earnings
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Cash Flow Hedge – Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity contracts
$
(7
)
 
$
(29
)
 
$
24

 
Cost of Sales
 
$
(10
)
 
$
(5
)
 
$
(16
)
Foreign exchange contracts
(1
)
 
(2
)
 
(8
)
 
Other Income/Expense
 

 
(4
)
 
4

Total
$
(8
)
 
$
(31
)
 
$
16

 
 
 
$
(10
)
 
$
(9
)
 
$
(12
)
Fair value hedges
We designate certain futures contracts as fair value hedges of firm commitments to purchase livestock for slaughter. Our objective of these hedges is to minimize the risk of changes in fair value created by fluctuations in commodity prices associated with fixed price livestock firm commitments. We had the following aggregated notional values of outstanding forward contracts entered into to hedge firm commitments which are accounted for as a fair value hedge:
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
 
Metric
 
September 27, 2014

 
September 28, 2013

Commodity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Live Cattle
 
Pounds
 
427

 
209

Lean Hogs
 
Pounds
 
329

 
384

For these derivative instruments we designate and qualify as a fair value hedge, the gain or loss on the derivative, as well as the offsetting gain or loss on the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk, are recognized in earnings in the same period. We include the gain or loss on the hedged items (i.e., livestock purchase firm commitments) in the same line item, Cost of Sales, as the offsetting gain or loss on the related livestock forward position.
 
 
in millions
 
 
 
Consolidated
Statements of Income
Classification
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Gain/(Loss) on forwards
 
Cost of Sales
 
$
(154
)
 
$
21

 
$
47

Gain/(Loss) on purchase contract
 
Cost of Sales
 
154

 
(21
)
 
(47
)
Ineffectiveness related to our fair value hedges was not significant during fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Undesignated positions
In addition to our designated positions, we also hold forward and option contracts for which we do not apply hedge accounting. These include certain derivative instruments related to commodities price risk, including grains, livestock, energy and foreign currency risk. We mark these positions to fair value through earnings at each reporting date. We generally do not enter into undesignated positions beyond 18 months.
The objective of our undesignated grains, livestock and energy commodity positions is to reduce the variability of cash flows associated with the forecasted purchase of certain grains, energy and livestock inputs to our production processes. We also enter into certain forward sales of boxed beef and boxed pork and forward purchases of cattle and hogs at fixed prices. The fixed price sales contracts lock in the proceeds from a future sale and the fixed cattle and hog purchases lock in the cost. However, the cost of the livestock and the related boxed beef and boxed pork market prices at the time of the sale or purchase could vary from this fixed price. As we enter into fixed forward sales of boxed beef and boxed pork and forward purchases of cattle and hogs, we also enter into the appropriate number of livestock options and futures positions to mitigate a portion of this risk. Changes in market value of the open livestock options and futures positions are marked to market and reported in earnings at each reporting date, even though the economic impact of our fixed prices being above or below the market price is only realized at the time of sale or purchase. These positions generally do not qualify for hedge treatment due to location basis differences between the commodity exchanges and the actual locations when we purchase the commodities.

67



We have a foreign currency cash flow hedging program to hedge portions of forecasted transactions denominated in foreign currencies, primarily with forward and option contracts, to protect against the reduction in value of forecasted foreign currency cash flows. Our undesignated foreign currency positions generally would qualify for cash flow hedge accounting. However, to reduce earnings volatility, we normally will not elect hedge accounting treatment when the position provides an offset to the underlying related transaction that impacts current earnings.
We had the following aggregate outstanding notional values related to our undesignated positions:
 
 
 
 
in millions, except soy meal tons
 
 
 
Metric
 
September 27, 2014

 
September 28, 2013

Commodity:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corn
 
Bushels
 

 
69

Soy Meal
 
Tons
 
195,800

 
204,600

Soy Oil
 
Pounds
 
3

 
11

Live Cattle
 
Pounds
 
22

 
60

Lean Hogs
 
Pounds
 
22

 
159

Foreign Currency
 
United States dollars
 
$
108

 
$
95

The following table sets forth the pretax impact of the undesignated derivative instruments in the Consolidated Statements of Income:
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
 
Consolidated
Statements of Income
Classification
 
Gain/(Loss)
Recognized
in Earnings
 
 
 
 
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity contracts
 
Sales
 
$
75

 
$
(10
)
 
$
(10
)
Commodity contracts
 
Cost of Sales
 
(136
)
 
(24
)
 
51

Foreign exchange contracts
 
Other Income/Expense
 

 
2

 

Total
 
 
 
$
(61
)
 
$
(32
)
 
$
41


68



The following table sets forth the fair value of all derivative instruments outstanding in the Consolidated Balance Sheets:
 
in millions
 
 
Fair Value
 
September 27, 2014

 
September 28, 2013

Derivative Assets:
 
 
 
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
Commodity contracts
$
17

 
$
4

Foreign exchange contracts

 
1

Total derivative assets – designated
17

 
5

 
 
 
 
Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
Commodity contracts
42

 
25

Foreign exchange contracts

 
2

Total derivative assets – not designated
42

 
27

 
 
 
 
Total derivative assets
$
59

 
$
32

Derivative Liabilities:
 
 
 
Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
Commodity contracts
$
78

 
$
29

Foreign exchange contracts

 

Total derivative liabilities – designated
78

 
29

 
 
 
 
Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:
 
 
 
Commodity contracts
80

 
72

Foreign exchange contracts
2

 
1

Total derivative liabilities – not designated
82

 
73

 
 
 
 
Total derivative liabilities
$
160

 
$
102

Our derivative assets and liabilities are presented in our Consolidated Balance Sheets on a net basis. We net derivative assets and liabilities, including cash collateral when a legally enforceable master netting arrangement exists between the counterparty to a derivative contract and us. See Note 13: Fair Value Measurements for a reconciliation to amounts reported in the Consolidated Balance Sheets in Other current assets and Other current liabilities.
NOTE 13: FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS
Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. The fair value hierarchy contains three levels as follows:
Level 1 — Unadjusted quoted prices available in active markets for the identical assets or liabilities at the measurement date.
Level 2 — Other observable inputs available at the measurement date, other than quoted prices included in Level 1, either directly or indirectly, including:
Quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets;
Quoted prices for identical or similar assets in non-active markets;
Inputs other than quoted prices that are observable for the asset or liability; and
Inputs derived principally from or corroborated by other observable market data.
Level 3 — Unobservable inputs that cannot be corroborated by observable market data and reflect the use of significant management judgment. These values are generally determined using pricing models for which the assumptions utilize management’s estimates of market participant assumptions.

69



Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis
The fair value hierarchy requires the use of observable market data when available. In instances where the inputs used to measure fair value fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy, the fair value measurement has been determined based on the lowest level input significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. Our assessment of the significance of a particular item to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment, including the consideration of inputs specific to the asset or liability.
The following tables set forth by level within the fair value hierarchy our financial assets and liabilities accounted for at fair value on a recurring basis according to the valuation techniques we used to determine their fair values:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
September 27, 2014
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Netting (a)

 
Total

Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity Derivatives
$

 
$
59

 
$

 
$
(50
)
 
$
9

Foreign Exchange Forward Contracts

 

 

 

 

Available for Sale Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current

 
1

 

 

 
1

Non-current
1

 
24

 
67

 

 
92

Deferred Compensation Assets
15

 
218

 

 

 
233

Total Assets
$
16

 
$
302

 
$
67

 
$
(50
)
 
$
335

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity Derivatives
$

 
$
158

 
$

 
$
(148
)
 
$
10

Foreign Exchange Forward Contracts

 
2

 

 

 
2

Total Liabilities
$

 
$
160

 
$

 
$
(148
)
 
$
12

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
September 28, 2013
Level 1

 
Level 2

 
Level 3

 
Netting (a)

 
Total

Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity Derivatives
$

 
$
29

 
$

 
$
(21
)
 
$
8

Foreign Exchange Forward Contracts

 
3

 

 
(1
)
 
2

Available for Sale Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current

 
1

 

 

 
1

Non-current
4

 
24

 
65

 

 
93

Deferred Compensation Assets
23

 
191

 

 

 
214

Total Assets
$
27

 
$
248

 
$
65

 
$
(22
)
 
$
318

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commodity Derivatives
$

 
$
101

 
$

 
$
(101
)
 
$

Foreign Exchange Forward Contracts

 
1

 

 

 
1

Total Liabilities
$

 
$
102

 
$

 
$
(101
)
 
$
1

(a)
Our derivative assets and liabilities are presented in our Consolidated Balance Sheets on a net basis. We net derivative assets and liabilities, including cash collateral, when a legally enforceable master netting arrangement exists between the counterparty to a derivative contract and us. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, we had posted with various counterparties $98 million and $79 million, respectively, of cash collateral related to our commodity derivatives and held no cash collateral.

70



The following table provides a reconciliation between the beginning and ending balance of debt securities measured at fair value on a recurring basis in the table above that used significant unobservable inputs (Level 3):
 
 
 
in millions

 
September 27, 2014

 
September 28, 2013

Balance at beginning of year
$
65

 
$
86

Total realized and unrealized gains (losses):
 
 
 
Included in earnings

 
1

Included in other comprehensive income (loss)

 

Purchases
25

 
19

Issuances

 

Settlements
(23
)
 
(41
)
Balance at end of year
$
67

 
$
65

Total gains (losses) for the periods included in earnings attributable to the change in unrealized gains (losses) relating to assets and liabilities still held at end of year
$

 
$

The following methods and assumptions were used to estimate the fair value of each class of financial instrument:
Derivative Assets and Liabilities: Our commodities and foreign exchange forward contracts primarily include exchange-traded and over-the-counter contracts which are further described in Note 12: Derivative Financial Instruments. We record our commodity derivatives at fair value using quoted market prices adjusted for credit and non-performance risk and internal models that use as their basis readily observable market inputs including current and forward commodity market prices. Our foreign exchange forward contracts are recorded at fair value based on quoted prices and spot and forward currency prices adjusted for credit and non-performance risk. We classify these instruments in Level 2 when quoted market prices can be corroborated utilizing observable current and forward commodity market prices on active exchanges or observable market transactions of spot currency rates and forward currency prices.
Available for Sale Securities: Our investments in marketable debt securities are classified as available-for-sale and are reported at fair value based on pricing models and quoted market prices adjusted for credit and non-performance risk. Short-term investments with maturities of less than 12 months are included in Other current assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets and primarily include certificates of deposit and commercial paper. All other marketable debt securities are included in Other Assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets and have maturities ranging up to 35 years. We classify our investments in U.S. government, U.S. agency, certificates of deposit and commercial paper debt securities as Level 2 as fair value is generally estimated using discounted cash flow models that are primarily industry-standard models that consider various assumptions, including time value and yield curve as well as other readily available relevant economic measures. We classify certain corporate, asset-backed and other debt securities as Level 3 as there is limited activity or less observable inputs into valuation models, including current interest rates and estimated prepayment, default and recovery rates on the underlying portfolio or structured investment vehicle. Significant changes to assumptions or unobservable inputs in the valuation of our Level 3 instruments would not have a significant impact to our consolidated financial statements.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
September 27, 2014
 
September 28, 2013
 
Amortized
Cost Basis

 
Fair
Value

 
Unrealized
Gain/(Loss)

 
Amortized
Cost Basis

 
Fair
Value

 
Unrealized
Gain/(Loss)

Available for Sale Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury and Agency
$
25

 
$
25

 
$

 
$
25

 
$
25

 
$

Corporate and Asset-Backed
65

 
67

 
2

 
64

 
65

 
1

Equity Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common Stock and Warrants (a)
1

 
1

 

 
9

 
4

 
(5
)
 
(a)
At September 27, 2014, the amortized cost basis for Equity Securities had been reduced by accumulated other than temporary impairment of approximately $2 million.

71



Unrealized holding gains (losses), net of tax, are excluded from earnings and reported in OCI until the security is settled or sold. On a quarterly basis, we evaluate whether losses related to our available-for-sale securities are temporary in nature. Losses on equity securities are recognized in earnings if the decline in value is judged to be other than temporary. If losses related to our debt securities are determined to be other than temporary, the loss would be recognized in earnings if we intend, or more likely than not will be required, to sell the security prior to recovery. For debt securities in which we have the intent and ability to hold until maturity, losses determined to be other than temporary would remain in OCI, other than expected credit losses which are recognized in earnings. We consider many factors in determining whether a loss is temporary, including the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been below cost, the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer and our ability and intent to hold the investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery. We recognized $6 million of other than temporary impairment for the year ended September 27, 2014, which is recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income in Other, net. No other than temporary losses were deferred in OCI as of September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013.
Deferred Compensation Assets: We maintain non-qualified deferred compensation plans for certain executives and other highly compensated employees. Investments are generally maintained within a trust and include money market funds, mutual funds and life insurance policies. The cash surrender value of the life insurance policies is invested primarily in mutual funds. The investments are recorded at fair value based on quoted market prices and are included in Other Assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets. We classify the investments which have observable market prices in active markets in Level 1 as these are generally publicly-traded mutual funds. The remaining deferred compensation assets are classified in Level 2, as fair value can be corroborated based on observable market data. Realized and unrealized gains (losses) on deferred compensation are included in earnings.
Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis
In addition to assets and liabilities that are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis, we record assets and liabilities at fair value on a nonrecurring basis. Generally, assets are recorded at fair value on a nonrecurring basis as a result of impairment charges.
In fiscal 2014, we recorded a $52 million impairment charge related to the closure of three Prepared Foods plants, which is recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income in Cost of Sales and in the Prepared Foods segment. Our valuation of these assets was primarily based on discounted cash flow models which included unobservable Level 3 inputs.
On July 28, 2014, we announced our plan to sell our Brazil operation. As a result, we recorded a $39 million charge to impair its assets to its fair value of $144 million. The impairment charge was recorded in the Consolidated Statements of Income in Cost of Sales and in the International segment. The fair value used to determine the impairment was based upon the contracted sales price.
Other Financial Instruments
Fair value of our debt is principally estimated using Level 2 inputs based on quoted prices for those or similar instruments. Fair value and carrying value for our debt are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
September 27, 2014
 
September 28, 2013
 
Fair
Value

 
Carrying
Value

 
Fair
Value

 
Carrying
Value

Total Debt
$
8,347

 
$
8,178

 
$
2,541

 
$
2,408

Concentrations of Credit Risk
Our financial instruments exposed to concentrations of credit risk consist primarily of cash and cash equivalents and accounts receivable. Our cash equivalents are in high quality securities placed with major banks and financial institutions. Concentrations of credit risk with respect to receivables are limited due to the large number of customers and their dispersion across geographic areas. We perform periodic credit evaluations of our customers’ financial condition and generally do not require collateral. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, 18.6% and 17.5%, respectively, of our net accounts receivable balance was due from Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. No other single customer or customer group represented greater than 10% of net accounts receivable.

72



NOTE 14: STOCK-BASED COMPENSATION
We issue shares under our stock-based compensation plans by issuing Class A stock from treasury. The total number of shares available for future grant under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan (Incentive Plan) was 30,428,186 at September 27, 2014.
Stock Options
Shareholders approved the Incentive Plan in January 2001. The Incentive Plan is administered by the Compensation and Leadership Development Committee of the Board of Directors (Compensation Committee). The Incentive Plan includes provisions for granting incentive stock options for shares of Class A stock at a price not less than the fair value at the date of grant. Nonqualified stock options may be granted at a price equal to or more than the fair value of Class A stock on the date the option is granted. Stock options under the Incentive Plan generally become exercisable ratably over three years from the date of grant and must be exercised within 10 years from the date of grant. Our policy is to recognize compensation expense on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period for the entire award.
 
Shares Under
Option

 
Weighted
Average Exercise
Price Per Share

 
Weighted Average
Remaining
Contractual Life
(in Years)
 
Aggregate
Intrinsic Value
(in millions)

Outstanding, September 28, 2013
13,912,168

 
$
16.59

 
 
 
 
Exercised
(4,168,070
)
 
16.13

 
 
 
 
Canceled
(270,989
)
 
23.79

 
 
 
 
Granted
4,251,300

 
31.82

 
 
 
 
Outstanding, September 27, 2014
13,724,409

 
$
21.30

 
7.0
 
$
226

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercisable, September 27, 2014
6,866,204

 
$
16.35

 
5.3
 
$
147

We generally grant stock options once a year. The weighted average grant-date fair value of options granted in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $10.83, $6.44 and $6.99, respectively. The fair value of each option grant is established on the date of grant using a binomial lattice method. We use historical volatility for a period of time comparable to the expected life of the option to determine volatility assumptions. Expected life is calculated based on the contractual term of each grant and takes into account the historical exercise and termination behavior of participants. Risk-free interest rates are based on the five-year Treasury bond rate. Assumptions as of the grant date used in the fair value calculation of each year’s grants are outlined in the following table.
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Expected life (in years)
6.0

 
6.2

 
6.7

Risk-free interest rate
1.3
%
 
0.7
%
 
0.9
%
Expected volatility
36.0
%
 
36.8
%
 
36.6
%
Expected dividend yield
1.0
%
 
1.0
%
 
1.0
%
We recognized stock-based compensation expense related to stock options, net of income taxes, of $20 million, $14 million and $15 million for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The related tax benefit for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $13 million, $9 million and $10 million, respectively. We had 4.8 million, 3.9 million and 3.4 million options vest in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, with a grant date fair value of $30 million, $22 million and $17 million, respectively.
In fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, we received cash of $67 million, $123 million and $34 million, respectively, for the exercise of stock options. Shares are issued from treasury for stock option exercises. The related tax benefit realized from stock options exercised during fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, was $33 million, $35 million and $7 million, respectively. The total intrinsic value of options exercised in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, was $87 million, $90 million and $21 million, respectively. Cash flows resulting from tax deductions in excess of the compensation cost of those options (excess tax deductions) are classified as financing cash flows. We realized $24 million, $18 million and $3 million related to excess tax deductions during fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
As of September 27, 2014, we had $35 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to stock option plans that will be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.4 years.

73



Restricted Stock
We issue restricted stock at the market value as of the date of grant, with restrictions expiring over periods through fiscal 2017. Unearned compensation is recognized over the vesting period for the particular grant using a straight-line method.
 
Number of Shares

 
Weighted
Average Grant-
Date Fair Value
Per Share

 
Weighted Average
Remaining
Contractual Life
(in Years)
 
Aggregate
Intrinsic Value
(in millions)

Nonvested, September 28, 2013
1,138,699

 
$
16.86

 
 
 
 
Granted
423,453

 
31.98

 
 
 
 
Dividends
9,225

 
37.14

 
 
 
 
Vested
(584,360
)
 
17.66

 
 
 
 
Forfeited
(48,073
)
 
20.83

 
 
 
 
Nonvested, September 27, 2014
938,944

 
$
23.18

 
1.2
 
$
35

As of September 27, 2014, we had $10 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to restricted stock awards that will be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.2 years.
We recognized stock-based compensation expense related to restricted stock, net of income taxes, of $6 million, $5 million and $7 million for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The related tax benefit for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $4 million, $3 million and $4 million, respectively. We had 0.6 million, 1.4 million and 1.2 million restricted stock awards vest in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, with a grant date fair value of $11 million, $20 million and $17 million, respectively.
Performance-Based Shares
We award performance-based shares of our Class A stock to certain senior executives. These awards are typically granted once a year. Performance-based shares vest based upon the passage of time and the achievement of performance or market performance criteria, ranging from 0% to 200%, as determined by the Compensation Committee prior to the date of the award. Vesting periods for these awards are generally three years. We review progress toward the attainment of the performance criteria each quarter during the vesting period. When it is probable the minimum performance criteria for an award will be achieved, we begin recognizing the expense equal to the proportionate share of the total fair value of the Class A stock price on the grant date. The total expense recognized over the duration of performance awards will equal the Class A stock price on the date of grant multiplied by the number of shares ultimately awarded based on the level of attainment of the performance criteria. For grants with market performance criteria, the total expense recognized over the duration of the award will equal the fair value as determined on the grant date, regardless if the market performance criteria is met.
The following table summarizes the performance-based shares at the maximum award amounts based upon the respective performance share agreements. Actual shares that will vest depend on the level of attainment of the performance-based criteria.
 
Number of Shares

 
Weighted
Average Grant-
Date Fair Value
Per Share

 
Weighted Average
Remaining
Contractual Life
(in Years)
Nonvested, September 28, 2013
1,001,310

 
$
20.99

 
 
Granted
585,418

 
35.66

 
 
Vested
(42,282
)
 
16.26

 
 
Forfeited
(140,843
)
 
23.68

 
 
Nonvested, September 27, 2014
1,403,603

 
$
26.77

 
1.5
We recognized stock-based compensation expense related to performance shares, net of income taxes, of $3.8 million, $2.4 million and $0.2 million for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The related tax benefit for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $2.5 million, $1.5 million and $0.1 million, respectively. As of September 27, 2014, we had $9 million of total unrecognized compensation based upon our progress toward the attainment of criteria related to performance-based share awards that will be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.5 years.

74



NOTE 15: PENSIONS AND OTHER POSTRETIREMENT BENEFITS
At September 27, 2014, we had nine defined benefit pension plans consisting of six funded qualified plans and three unfunded non-qualified plans. In regards to our qualified plans, five are frozen and noncontributory. The benefits provided under these plans are based on a formula using years of service and either a specified benefit rate or compensation level. The non-qualified defined benefit plans are for certain contracted officers and use a formula based on years of service and final average salary. We also have other postretirement benefit plans for which substantially all of our employees may receive benefits if they satisfy applicable eligibility criteria. The postretirement healthcare plans are contributory with participants’ contributions adjusted when deemed necessary.
We have defined contribution retirement programs for various groups of employees. We recognized expenses of $53 million, $50 million and $47 million in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
We use a fiscal year end measurement date for our defined benefit plans and other postretirement plans. We recognize the effect of actuarial gains and losses into earnings immediately for other postretirement plans rather than amortizing the effect over future periods.
Other postretirement benefits include postretirement medical costs and life insurance.
Benefit Obligations and Funded Status
The following table provides a reconciliation of the changes in the plans’ benefit obligations, assets and funded status at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
Pension Benefits
 
Other Postretirement
 
Qualified
 
Non-Qualified
 
Benefits
 
2014

 
2013

 
2014

 
2013

 
2014

 
2013

Change in benefit obligation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation at beginning of year
$
86

 
$
101

 
$
85

 
$
81

 
$
71

 
$
64

Service cost
1

 

 
7

 
5

 
2

 
2

Interest cost
10

 
4

 
5

 
3

 
3

 
2

Plan participants’ contributions

 

 

 

 
1

 
1

Actuarial (gain)/loss
(37
)
 
(9
)
 
15

 
(2
)
 
(8
)
 
7

Benefits paid
(11
)
 
(10
)
 
(3
)
 
(2
)
 
(6
)
 
(5
)
Business acquisition
1,800

 

 
73

 

 
100

 

Benefit obligation at end of year
1,849

 
86

 
182

 
85

 
163

 
71

Change in plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year
85

 
86

 

 

 

 

Actual return on plan assets
(36
)
 
3

 

 

 

 

Employer contributions
6

 
6

 
3

 
2

 
5

 
4

Plan participants’ contributions

 

 

 

 
1

 
1

Benefits paid
(11
)
 
(10
)
 
(3
)
 
(2
)
 
(6
)
 
(5
)
Business acquisition
1,603

 

 
3

 

 

 

Fair value of plan assets at end of year
1,647

 
85

 
3

 

 

 

Funded status
$
(202
)
 
$
(1
)
 
$
(179
)
 
$
(85
)
 
$
(163
)
 
$
(71
)

75



Amounts recognized in the Consolidated Balance Sheets consist of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
Pension Benefits
 
Other Postretirement
 
Qualified
 
Non-Qualified
 
Benefits
 
2014

 
2013

 
2014

 
2013

 
2014

 
2013

Other current liabilities
$

 
$

 
$
(5
)
 
$

 
$
(7
)
 
$

Other liabilities
(202
)
 
(1
)
 
(174
)
 
(85
)
 
(156
)
 
(71
)
Accumulated other comprehensive (income)/loss:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   Actuarial loss
39

 
30

 
36

 
23

 

 

   Prior service cost/(credit)

 

 

 

 
(2
)
 
(3
)
Net amount recognized
$
(163
)
 
$
29

 
$
(143
)
 
$
(62
)
 
$
(165
)
 
$
(74
)
At September 27, 2014, seven pension plans had an accumulated benefit obligation in excess of plan assets. At September 28, 2013, three pension plans had an accumulated benefit obligation in excess of plan assets. Plans with accumulated benefit obligations in excess of plan assets are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
Pension Benefits
 
Qualified
 
Non-Qualified
 
2014

 
2013

 
2014

 
2013

Projected benefit obligation
$
1,829

 
$
27

 
$
182

 
$
85

Accumulated benefit obligation
1,829

 
27

 
172

 
72

Fair value of plan assets
1,627

 
26

 
3

 

The accumulated benefit obligation for all qualified pension plans was $1,849 million and $86 million at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively.
Net Periodic Benefit Cost
Components of net periodic benefit cost for pension and postretirement benefit plans recognized in the Consolidated Statements of Income are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
Pension Benefits
 
Other Postretirement
 
Qualified
 
Non-Qualified
 
Benefits
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Service cost
$
1

 
$

 
$

 
$
7

 
$
5

 
$
5

 
$
2

 
$
2

 
$
1

Interest cost
10

 
4

 
4

 
5

 
3

 
3

 
3

 
2

 
2

Expected return on plan assets
(13
)
 
(5
)
 
(6
)
 

 

 

 

 

 

Amortization of prior service cost

 

 

 

 
1

 
1

 

 
(1
)
 
(1
)
Recognized actuarial (gain) loss, net
2

 
4

 
3

 
2

 
3

 
1

 
(8
)
 
7

 
24

Net periodic benefit cost
$

 
$
3

 
$
1

 
$
14

 
$
12

 
$
10

 
$
(3
)
 
$
10

 
$
26

As of September 27, 2014, the amounts expected to be reclassified into earnings within the next 12 months related to net periodic benefit cost for the qualified and non-qualified pensions are $2 million and $4 million, respectively.

76



Assumptions
Weighted average assumptions are as follows:
 
Pension Benefits
 
Other Postretirement
 
Qualified
 
Non-Qualified
 
Benefits
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Discount rate to determine net periodic benefit cost
4.37
%
 
4.02
%
 
4.53
%
 
5.01
%
 
4.23
%
 
4.75
%
 
4.41
%
 
3.66
%
 
4.09
%
Discount rate to determine benefit obligations
4.32
%
 
4.77
%
 
4.02
%
 
4.36
%
 
5.09
%
 
4.23
%
 
3.97
%
 
4.48
%
 
3.66
%
Rate of compensation increase
0.01
%
 
N/A

 
N/A

 
2.11
%
 
3.50
%
 
3.50
%
 
N/A

 
N/A

 
N/A

Expected return on plan assets
6.37
%
 
5.44
%
 
6.37
%
 
N/A

 
N/A

 
N/A

 
N/A

 
N/A

 
N/A

To determine the expected return on plan assets assumption, we first examined historical rates of return for the various asset classes within the plans. We then determined a long-term projected rate-of-return based on expected returns.
Our discount rate assumptions used to account for pension and other postretirement benefit plans reflect the rates at which the benefit obligations could be effectively settled. These were determined using a cash flow matching technique whereby the rates of a yield curve, developed from high-quality debt securities, were applied to the benefit obligations to determine the appropriate discount rate. As of September 27, 2014, all pension and other postretirement benefit plans used the RP-2014 mortality tables. At September 28, 2013, the pension plans used the 2013 IRS mortality tables while the other postretirement benefit plans used either the RP-2000 or the 2013 IRS mortality tables to align with applicable participant data.
We have six other postretirement benefit plans which are healthcare and life insurance related. Two of these plans, which benefit obligations totaled $22 million at September 27, 2014, were not impacted by healthcare cost trend rates as they consist of fixed annual payments. The remaining plans, which benefit obligations were $141 million at September 27, 2014, covering retirees who do not yet qualify for Medicare utilized an assumed healthcare cost trend rate of 7.3% and those covering retirees who do qualify for Medicare utilized an assumed healthcare cost trend of 6.5%. The healthcare cost trend rate will be grading down to an ultimate rate of 5.0% in 2021/2022. A one-percentage-point change in assumed health-care cost trend rates would have the following effects:
 
 
 
in millions

 
One Percentage Point Increase
 
One Percentage Point Decrease
Effect on postretirement benefit obligation
$
17

 
$
13

Effect on total service and interest components
2

 
1

Plan Assets
The following table sets forth the actual and target asset allocation for pension plan assets:
 
2014

 
2013

 
Target Asset
Allocation

Cash
4.9
%
 
1.6
%
 
0.3
%
Fixed Income Securities
80.5

 
79.1

 
84.9

U.S. Stock Funds
6.0

 
4.3

 
5.4

International Stock Funds
6.2

 
7.3

 
6.3

Real Estate
2.0

 
3.8

 
2.0

Other
0.4

 
3.9

 
1.1

Total
100.0
%
 
100.0
%
 
100.0
%
Additionally, one of our foreign subsidiary pension plans had $15 million and $14 million in plan assets held in an insurance trust at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively.
The plan trustees have established a set of investment objectives related to the assets of the domestic pension plans and regularly monitor the performance of the funds and portfolio managers. Objectives for the pension assets are (i) to provide growth of capital and income, (ii) to achieve a target weighted average annual rate of return competitive with funds with similar investment objectives and (iii) to diversify to reduce risk. The target asset allocations are based upon the funded status of the plans. As pension obligations become better funded, we will lower risk by increasing the allocation to fixed income.

77



As noted in the previous table, on an aggregate fair value basis, the plan assets are currently at approximately 81% fixed income securities and 12% equity securities. Fixed income securities can include, but are not limited to, direct bond investments, and pooled or indirect bond investments. Other investments may include, but are not limited to, international and domestic equities, real estate, commodities and private equity. Derivative instruments may also be used in concert with either fixed income or equity investments to achieve desired exposure or to hedge certain risks. Derivative instruments can include, but are not limited to, futures, options, swaps or swaptions. We believe there are no significant concentrations of risk within our plan assets as of September 27, 2014.
The following tables show the categories of pension plan assets and the level under which fair values were determined in the fair value hierarchy, which is described in Note 13: Fair Value Measurements.
 
in millions
 
September 27, 2014
Level 1

 
Level 2 (a)

 
Level 3 (b)

 
Total

Cash and cash equivalents
$
79

 
$

 
$

 
$
79

Fixed Income Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bond and fixed income funds

 
377

 

 
377

Corporate bonds

 
680

 

 
680

Government and municipal bonds

 
253

 

 
253

Mortgage backed securities

 

 
7

 
7

Total fixed income securities

 
1,310

 
7

 
1,317

Equity Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 


U.S. securities funds

 
84

 

 
84

Non-U.S. securities funds

 
101

 

 
101

Commodity funds

 
14

 

 
14

Global real estate funds

 
33

 

 
33

Total equity securities

 
232

 

 
232

Other

 
7

 

 
7

Insurance Contract at Contract Value

 

 
15

 
15

Total plan assets
$
79

 
$
1,549

 
$
22

 
$
1,650

 
in millions
 
September 28, 2013
Level 1

 
Level 2 (a)

 
Level 3 (b)

 
Total

Cash and cash equivalents
$
1

 
$

 
$

 
$
1

Fixed Income Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bond and fixed income funds

 
56

 

 
56

Corporate bonds

 

 

 

Government and municipal bonds

 

 

 

Mortgage backed securities

 

 

 

Total fixed income securities

 
56

 

 
56

Equity Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. securities funds

 
3

 

 
3

Non-U.S. securities funds

 
5

 

 
5

Commodity funds

 

 

 

Global real estate funds

 
3

 

 
3

Total equity securities

 
11

 

 
11

Other

 

 
3

 
3

Insurance Contract at Contract Value

 

 
14

 
14

Total plan assets
$
1

 
$
67

 
$
17

 
$
85


78



(a)
We classify our investments in U.S. government, U.S. agency, fixed income funds, bond funds, corporate bonds, and other debt securities as Level 2 as fair value is generally estimated using discounted cash flow models that are primarily industry-standard models that consider various assumptions, including time value and yield curve as well as other readily available relevant economic measures. Funds are valued using the net asset value (NAV) provided by the trustee, which is a practical expedient to estimating fair value. The NAV is based on the fair value of the underlying investments within the funds and is determined daily.
(b)
We classify certain mortgage-backed, asset-backed and insurance contracts as Level 3 as there is limited activity or less observable inputs into valuation models, including current interest rates and estimated prepayment, default and recovery rates on the underlying portfolio or structured investment vehicle. The insurance contracts are valued using the plan’s own assumptions about the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the assets based on the best information available, such as investment manager pricing. Significant changes to assumptions or unobservable inputs in the valuation of our Level 3 instruments would not have a significant impact to our consolidated financial statements.
A reconciliation of the change in the fair value measurement of the defined benefit plans’ consolidated assets using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) is as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
Mortgage backed securities

 
Other 

 
Insurance contract

 
Total

Balance at September 28, 2013
$

 
$
3

 
$
14

 
17

Actual return on plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 


Assets still held at reporting date

 

 

 

Assets sold during the period

 

 

 

Purchases, sales and settlements, net

 

 
1

 
1

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3
7

 
(3
)
 

 
4

Balance at September 27, 2014
$
7

 
$

 
$
15

 
$
22

Contributions
Our policy is to fund at least the minimum contribution required to meet applicable federal employee benefit and local tax laws. In our sole discretion, we may from time to time fund additional amounts. Expected contributions to pension plans for fiscal 2015 are approximately $14 million. For fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, we funded $9 million, $8 million and $8 million plans, respectively, to pension plans.
Estimated Future Benefit Payments    
The following benefit payments are expected to be paid:
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
Pension Benefits
 
Other Postretirement
 
Qualified
 
Non-Qualified
 
Benefits
2015
$
108

 
$
8

 
$
12

2016
82

 
9

 
12

2017
85

 
9

 
12

2018
89

 
9

 
12

2019
92

 
10

 
12

2020-2024
506

 
54

 
64

The above benefit payments for other postretirement benefit plans are not expected to be offset by Medicare Part D subsidies in 2015 or thereafter.

79



Multi-Employer Plans
Additionally, we participate in a multi-employer plan that provides defined benefits to certain employees covered by collective bargaining agreements. Such plans are usually administered by a board of trustees composed of the management of the participating companies and labor representatives.
The risks of participating in multiemployer plans are different from single-employer plans. Assets contributed to the multiemployer plan by one employer may be used to provide benefits to employees of other participating employers. If a participating employer stops contributing to the plan, the unfunded obligation of the plan may be borne by the remaining participating employers. If we stop participating in a plan, we may be required to pay that plan an amount based on the underfunded status of the plan, referred to as a withdrawal liability. Contributions to the pension funds were not in excess of 5% of the total plan contributions for plan year 2014. There are no contractually required minimum contributions to the plans as of September 27, 2014.
The net pension cost of the plan is equal to the annual contribution determined in accordance with the provisions of negotiated labor contracts. Contributions to the plan were less than $1 million in fiscal 2014. Assets contributed to such plans are not segregated or otherwise restricted to provide benefits only to our employees. The future cost of the plan is dependent on a number of factors including the funded status of the plan and the ability of the other participating companies to meet ongoing funding obligations.
Our participation in this multiemployer plan for fiscal 2014 is outlined below. The EIN/Pension Plan Number column provides the Employer Identification Number (EIN) and the three digit plan number. Unless otherwise noted, the most recent Pension Protection Act ("PPA") zone status available in 2014 and 2013 is for the plan's year beginning January 1, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The zone status is based on information that we have received from the plan and is certified by the plan's actuaries. Among other factors, plans in the red zone are generally less than 65 percent funded. The FIP/RP Status Pending/Implemented column indicates plans for which a financial improvement plan (FIP) or rehabilitation plan (RP) is either pending or has been implemented. The last column lists the expiration date(s) of the collective-bargaining agreements to which the plan is subject. There have been no significant changes that affect the comparability of contributions from year to year.
In addition to regular contributions, we could be obligated to pay additional contributions (known as complete or partial withdrawal liabilities) if it has unfunded vested benefits.
 
 
 
PPA Zone Status
 
FIP/RP Status
Contributions (in millions)
 
Surcharge Imposed
 
 
Pension Fund Plan Name
EIN/Pension Plan Number
 
2014
 
2013
 
Pending/ Implemented
2014
 
2014
 
Expiration Date of Collective Bargaining Agreement
Bakery and Confectionary Union & Industry International Pension Fund
52-6118572/001
 
Red
 
Red
 
Nov 2012
 
$1
 
10%
 
Oct 2015


80



NOTE 16: COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
The components of accumulated other comprehensive loss are as follows:
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of taxes:
 
 
 
Unrealized net hedging gain (loss)
$
(3
)
 
$
(4
)
Unrealized net gain (loss) on investments
2

 
(2
)
Currency translation adjustment
(99
)
 
(69
)
Postretirement benefits reserve adjustments
(47
)
 
(33
)
Total accumulated other comprehensive loss
$
(147
)
 
$
(108
)
The before and after tax changes in the components of other comprehensive income (loss) are as follows:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
Before Tax
Tax
After Tax
 
Before Tax
Tax
After Tax
 
Before Tax
Tax
After Tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivatives accounted for as cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Gain) loss reclassified to Cost of Sales
 
$
10

$
(4
)
$
6

 
$
5

$
(2
)
$
3

 
$
16

$
(7
)
$
9

(Gain) loss reclassified to Other Income/Expense
 



 
4

(2
)
2

 
(4
)
2

(2
)
Unrealized gain (loss)
 
(8
)
3

(5
)
 
(31
)
12

(19
)
 
16

(6
)
10

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Gain) loss reclassified to Other Income/Expense
 
8

(2
)
6

 
(1
)

(1
)
 



Unrealized gain (loss)
 
(2
)

(2
)
 
(4
)
2

(2
)
 



 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Currency translation:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Translation gain reclassified to Other Income/Expense
 



 
(19
)
(1
)
(20
)
 



Translation adjustment
 
(32
)
2

(30
)
 
(20
)
3

(17
)
 
2

1

3

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Postretirement benefits
 
(23
)
9

(14
)
 
15

(6
)
9

 
(6
)
2

(4
)
Total Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
 
$
(47
)
$
8

$
(39
)
 
$
(51
)
$
6

$
(45
)
 
$
24

$
(8
)
$
16


81



NOTE 17: SEGMENT REPORTING
We operate in five segments: Chicken, Beef, Pork, Prepared Foods and International. We measure segment profit as operating income (loss).
During the second quarter of fiscal 2014, we began reporting our International operation as a separate segment, which was previously included in our Chicken segment. Our International segment became a separate reportable segment as a result of changes to our internal financial reporting to align with previously announced executive leadership changes. All periods presented have been reclassified to reflect this change. Beef, Pork, Prepared Foods and Other results were not impacted by this change.
Chicken: Chicken includes our domestic operations related to raising and processing live chickens into fresh, frozen and value-added chicken products, as well as sales from allied products. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets. This segment also includes logistics operations to move products through our domestic supply chain and the global operations of our chicken breeding stock subsidiary.
Beef: Beef includes our operations related to processing live fed cattle and fabricating dressed beef carcasses into primal and sub-primal meat cuts and case-ready products. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets. This segment also includes sales from allied products such as hides and variety meats, as well as logistics operations to move products through the supply chain.
Pork: Pork includes our operations related to processing live market hogs and fabricating pork carcasses into primal and sub-primal cuts and case-ready products. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets. This segment also includes our live swine group, related allied product processing activities and logistics operations to move products through the supply chain.
Prepared Foods: Prepared Foods includes our operations related to manufacturing and marketing frozen and refrigerated food products and logistics operations to move products through the supply chain. Products primarily include pepperoni, bacon, sausage, beef and pork pizza toppings, pizza crusts, flour and corn tortilla products, appetizers, prepared meals, ethnic foods, soups, sauces, side dishes, meat dishes, breadsticks and processed meats. Products are marketed domestically to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains and noncommercial foodservice establishments such as schools, healthcare facilities, the military and other food processors, as well as to international export markets.
On August 28, 2014, we completed the acquisition of Hillshire Brands, a manufacturer and marketer of branded, convenient foods which includes brands such as Jimmy Dean®, Ball Park®, Hillshire Farm®, State Fair®, Van's®, Sara Lee® frozen bakery and Chef Pierre® pies as well as artisanal brands Aidells®, Gallo Salame®, and Golden Island® premium jerky. Hillshire Brands' one month results from operations for fiscal 2014 are included in the Prepared Foods segment.
International: International includes our foreign operations primarily related to raising and processing live chickens into fresh, frozen and value-added chicken products in Brazil, China, India and Mexico. Products are marketed in each respective country to food retailers, foodservice distributors, restaurant operators, hotel chains, noncommercial foodservice establishments and live markets, as well as to other international export markets.
On July 28, 2014, we announced our plan to sell our Brazil and Mexico operations, part of our International segment, to JBS for $575 million in cash. We expect to complete the sale of our Brazil operation in the first quarter of fiscal 2015. The sale of our Mexico operation is pending the necessary government approvals and is expected to close in the first half of fiscal 2015.

82



The results from Dynamic Fuels are included in Other. We allocate expenses related to corporate activities to the segments, except for acquisition and integration related fees of $59 million which are included in Other. Assets and additions to property, plant and equipment relating to corporate activities remain in Other. At September 27, 2014, we included $4.8 billion of goodwill associated with our acquisition of Hillshire Brands in Other. The allocation of goodwill to our reportable segments is pending finalization of the expected synergies and the impact of the synergies to our reporting units.
Information on segments and a reconciliation to income from continuing operations before income taxes are follows:
 
in millions
 
 
Chicken

 
Beef

 
Pork

 
Prepared
Foods

 
International

 
Other

 
Intersegment
Sales

 
Consolidated

Fiscal 2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
$
11,116

 
$
16,177

 
$
6,304

 
$
3,927

 
$
1,381

 
$

 
$
(1,325
)
 
$
37,580

Operating Income (Loss)
883

 
347

 
455

 
(60
)
 
(121
)
 
(74
)
 
 
 
1,430

Total Other (Income) Expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
178

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Taxes
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,252

Depreciation
251

 
87

 
32

 
78

 
40

 
6

 
 
 
494

Total Assets
4,807

 
3,103

 
965

 
8,608

 
871

 
5,602

 
 
 
23,956

Additions to property, plant and equipment
307

 
115

 
36

 
77

 
46

 
51

 
 
 
632

Fiscal 2013
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
$
10,988

 
$
14,400

 
$
5,408

 
$
3,322

 
$
1,324

 
$
46

 
$
(1,114
)
 
$
34,374

Operating Income (Loss)
683

 
296

 
332

 
101

 
(37
)
 

 
 
 
1,375

Total Other (Income) Expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
118

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Taxes
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1,257

Depreciation
251

 
87

 
30

 
61

 
40

 
5

 
 
 
474

Total Assets
4,944

 
2,798

 
931

 
1,176

 
876

 
1,452

 
 
 
12,177

Additions to property, plant and equipment
253

 
105

 
22

 
87

 
58

 
33

 
 
 
558

Fiscal 2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
$
10,270

 
$
13,755

 
$
5,510

 
$
3,237

 
$
1,104

 
$
167

 
$
(988
)
 
$
33,055

Operating Income (Loss)
554

 
218

 
417

 
181

 
(70
)
 
(14
)
 
 
 
1,286

Total Other (Income) Expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
321

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Taxes
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
965

Depreciation
228

 
86

 
30

 
54

 
40

 
5

 
 
 
443

Total Assets
4,934

 
2,634

 
895

 
960

 
968

 
1,505

 
 
 
11,896

Additions to property, plant and equipment
354

 
100

 
32

 
99

 
97

 
8

 
 
 
690

The Chicken segment had sales of $7 million, $16 million and $6 million for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, from transactions with other operating segments. The Pork segment had sales of $1.0 billion, $872 million and $771 million for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, from transactions with other operating segments. The Beef segment had sales of $307 million, $226 million and $211 million for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, from transactions with other operating segments. The aforementioned sales from intersegment transactions, which were at market prices, were included in the segment sales in the above table.
Our largest customer, Wal-Mart Stores, Inc., accounted for 14.6%, 13.0% and 13.8% of consolidated sales in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Sales to Wal-Mart Stores, Inc. were included in the all segments. Any extended discontinuance of sales to this customer could, if not replaced, have a material impact on our operations.

83



The majority of our operations are domiciled in the United States. Approximately 96%, 96% and 95% of sales to external customers for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, were sourced from the United States. Approximately $17.4 billion and $6.1 billion of long-lived assets were located in the United States at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively. Approximately $324 million and $485 million of long-lived assets were located in foreign countries, primarily Brazil, China and India, at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively.
We sell certain products in foreign markets, primarily Brazil, Canada, Central America, China, the European Union, Japan, Mexico, the Middle East, South Korea, Taiwan, and Vietnam. Our export sales from the United States totaled $4.7 billion, $4.2 billion and $4.0 billion for fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Substantially all of our export sales are facilitated through unaffiliated brokers, marketing associations and foreign sales staffs. Sales of products produced in a country other than the United States were less than 10% of consolidated sales for each of fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012.
NOTE 18: SUPPLEMENTAL CASH FLOWS INFORMATION
The following table summarizes cash payments for interest and income taxes:
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Interest, net of amounts capitalized
$
118

 
$
114

 
$
274

Income taxes, net of refunds
590

 
310

 
187

NOTE 19: TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES
We have operating leases for two wastewater facilities with an entity owned by the Donald J. Tyson Revocable Trust (for which Mr. John Tyson, Chairman of the Company, is a trustee), Berry Street Waste Water Treatment Plant, LP (90% of which is owned by TLP), and the sisters of Mr. Tyson. Total payments of approximately $1 million in each of fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 were paid to lease the facilities.
In fiscal 2014, we purchased real estate from JHT, LLC, for $0.5 million to build a new data center. The JHT, LLC (for which Mr. John Tyson is the manager), is owned 50% by the Donald J. Tyson Revocable Trust and 50% by the Randal W. Tyson Testamentary Trust.
As of September 27, 2014, the TLP, of which John Tyson and director Barbara Tyson are general partners, owned 70 million shares, or 99.985% of Class B stock and, along with the members of the Tyson family, owned 5.5 million shares of Class A stock, giving it control of approximately 70.14% of the total voting power of our outstanding voting stock. In fiscal 2013, as part of the Company's previously approved stock repurchase plan, we purchased one million shares of Class A stock from the TLP for $29.85 million or $29.85 per share. 
In fiscal 2012, we had an aircraft lease agreement with Tyson Family Aviation, LLC, of which Mr. Don Tyson (formerly our Senior Chairman), Mr. John Tyson and the Randal W. Tyson Testamentary Trust were members. Upon Mr. Don Tyson’s death on January 6, 2011, his membership interest passed to a trust in which Mr. John Tyson is a trustee. During fiscal 2012, Tyson Family Aviation, LLC sold the aircraft to a non-related party and we entered into an aircraft lease agreement with the new owner. Total payments to Tyson Family Aviation, LLC of approximately $0.4 million were paid in fiscal 2012.

84



NOTE 20: COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
Commitments
We lease equipment, properties and certain farms for which total rentals approximated $161 million, $200 million and $193 million, in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Most leases have initial terms of up to seven years, some with varying renewal periods. The most significant obligations assumed under the terms of the leases are the upkeep of the facilities and payments of insurance and property taxes.
Minimum lease commitments under non-cancelable leases at September 27, 2014, were:
 
in millions

2015
$
107

2016
80

2017
56

2018
39

2019
30

2020 and beyond
104

Total
$
416

We guarantee obligations of certain outside third parties, consisting primarily of leases and grower loans which are substantially collateralized by the underlying assets. Terms of the underlying debt cover periods up to 15 years, and the maximum potential amount of future payments as of September 27, 2014, was $70 million. We also maintain operating leases for various types of equipment, some of which contain residual value guarantees for the market value of the underlying leased assets at the end of the term of the lease. The remaining terms of the lease maturities cover periods over the next 13 years. The maximum potential amount of the residual value guarantees is $54 million, of which $48 million could be recoverable through various recourse provisions and an additional undeterminable recoverable amount based on the fair value of the underlying leased assets. The likelihood of material payments under these guarantees is not considered probable. At September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, no material liabilities for guarantees were recorded.
We have cash flow assistance programs in which certain livestock suppliers participate. Under these programs, we pay an amount for livestock equivalent to a standard cost to grow such livestock during periods of low market sales prices. The amounts of such payments that are in excess of the market sales price are recorded as receivables and accrue interest. Participating suppliers are obligated to repay these receivables balances when market sales prices exceed this standard cost, or upon termination of the agreement. Our maximum obligation associated with these programs is limited to the fair value of each participating livestock supplier’s net tangible assets. The potential maximum obligation as of September 27, 2014, was approximately $330 million. The total receivables under these programs were $4 million and $44 million at September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013, respectively, and are included, net of allowance for uncollectible amounts, in Accounts Receivable in our Consolidated Balance Sheets. Even though these programs are limited to the net tangible assets of the participating livestock suppliers, we also manage a portion of our credit risk associated with these programs by obtaining security interests in livestock suppliers’ assets. After analyzing residual credit risks and general market conditions, we had no allowance for these programs' estimated uncollectible receivables at September 27, 2014 and $15 million at September 28, 2013.
Additionally, we enter into future purchase commitments for various items, such as grains, livestock contracts and fixed grower fees. At September 27, 2014, these commitments totaled:
 
in millions

2015
$
2,625

2016
585

2017
259

2018
271

2019
189

2020 and beyond
249

Total
$
4,178


85



Contingencies
We are involved in various claims and legal proceedings. We routinely assess the likelihood of adverse judgments or outcomes to those matters, as well as ranges of probable losses, to the extent losses are reasonably estimable. We record accruals for such matters to the extent that we conclude a loss is probable and the financial impact, should an adverse outcome occur, is reasonably estimable. Such accruals are reflected in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. In our opinion, we have made appropriate and adequate accruals for these matters and believe the probability of a material loss beyond the amounts accrued to be remote; however, the ultimate liability for these matters is uncertain, and if accruals are not adequate, an adverse outcome could have a material effect on the consolidated financial condition or results of operations. Listed below are certain claims made against the Company and/or our subsidiaries for which the potential exposure is considered material to the Company’s consolidated financial statements. We believe we have substantial defenses to the claims made and intend to vigorously defend these matters.
There are nine pending lawsuits involving our beef and pork plants, in which certain present and past employees allege that we failed to compensate them for the time it takes to engage in pre- and post-shift activities, such as changing into and out of protective and sanitary clothing and walking to and from the changing area, work areas and break areas in violation of the Fair Labor Standards Act and various state laws. The plaintiffs seek back wages, liquidated damages, pre- and post-judgment interest, attorneys’ fees and costs. Each case is proceeding in its jurisdiction.
Garcia, et al. v. Tyson Foods, Inc., Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc., D. Kansas, May 15, 2006 - After a trial involving our Garden City, Kansas beef plant, a jury verdict in favor of the plaintiffs was entered on March 17, 2011. Exclusive of pre- and post-judgment interest, attorneys’ fees and costs, the jury found violations of federal and state laws for pre- and post-shift work activities and awarded damages in the amount of $503,011. Plaintiffs’ counsel filed an application for attorneys’ fees and expenses which we contested. On December 7, 2012, the court granted plaintiffs' counsel's application and awarded a total of $3,609,723. We appealed the jury’s verdict and trial court’s award to the Tenth Circuit Court of Appeals. The appellate court affirmed the jury verdict and judgment and subsequently denied our petition for rehearing.
Bouaphakeo (f/k/a Sharp), et al. v. Tyson Foods, Inc., N.D. Iowa, February 6, 2007 - A jury trial was held involving our Storm Lake, Iowa pork plant which resulted in a jury verdict in favor of the plaintiffs for violations of federal and state laws for pre- and post-shift work activities. The trial court also awarded the plaintiffs liquidated damages, resulting in total damages awarded in the amount of $5,784,758. The plaintiffs' counsel has also filed an application for attorneys' fees and expenses in the amount of $2,692,145. We appealed the jury's verdict and trial court's award to the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals. The appellate court affirmed the jury verdict and judgment on August 25, 2014, and we filed a petition for rehearing on September 22, 2014.
Guyton (f/k/a Robinson), et al. v. Tyson Foods, Inc., d.b.a Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc., S.D. Iowa, September 12, 2007 - A jury trial was held involving our Columbus Junction, Iowa pork plant, which resulted in a jury verdict in favor of Tyson on April 25, 2012. The plaintiffs have appealed to the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals. Oral arguments were held on February 11, 2014. The appellate court affirmed the jury verdict and judgment on August 25, 2014.
Acosta, et al. v Tyson Foods, Inc. d.b.a Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc., D. Nebraska, February 29, 2008 - A bench trial was held involving our Madison, Nebraska pork plant, in January 2013. In May 2013 the trial court awarded the plaintiffs $5,733,943 for unpaid overtime wages. Subsequently, the court ordered the class of plaintiffs expanded, and the plaintiffs submitted an updated calculation of $6,258,330 for unpaid overtime wages as reflected by payroll data through May 2013. On January 30, 2014, the trial court entered judgment in favor of the plaintiffs in the amount of $18,774,989, which represents a tripling of the plaintiffs’ alleged damages. The court denied our post-trial motions, and we appealed to the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals.
Gomez, et al. v. Tyson Foods, Inc., D. Nebraska, January 16, 2008 - A jury trial involving our Dakota City, Nebraska beef plant, was held, and the jury found in favor of the plaintiffs on April 3, 2013. On October 2, 2013, the trial court denied the parties’ post-trial motions and entered judgment awarding unpaid overtime wages, liquidated damages, and penalties totaling $4,960,787. We appealed the jury’s verdict and trial court’s award to the Eighth Circuit Court of Appeals.
Edwards, et al. v. Tyson Foods, Inc. d.b.a Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc., S.D. Iowa, March 20, 2008 - The trial court in this case, which involves our Perry and Waterloo, Iowa pork plants, decertified the state law class and granted other pre-trial motions that resulted in judgment in our favor with respect to the plaintiffs’ claims. The plaintiffs have filed a motion to modify this judgment.
Abadeer v. Tyson Foods, Inc., and Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc., M.D. Tennessee, February 6, 2009 - The trial court in the Abadeer case, which involves our Goodlettsville, Tennessee case-ready beef and pork plant, granted the plaintiffs’ motion for summary judgment in part, finding that certain pre- and post-shift activities were compensable and our non-payment for those activities was willful and not in good faith. The parties subsequently agreed to settle all claims for $7,750,000. The parties' joint motion for approval of settlement was granted.
Abdiaziz, et al. v. Tyson Foods, Inc., Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc., D. Kansas, September 30, 2011 - this case involves our Emporia, Kansas beef plant, and was bifurcated from the case involving our Garden City, Kansas beef plant. It is stayed pending the resolution of that matter.

86



Murray, et al. v. Tyson Foods, Inc., C.D. Illinois, January 2, 2008; and DeVoss v. Tyson Foods, Inc. d.b.a. Tyson Fresh Meats, C.D. Illinois, March 2, 2011 - these cases involve our Joslin, Illinois beef plant and are in their preliminary stages.
Our subsidiary, The Hillshire Brands Company (formerly named Sara Lee Corporation), is a party to a consolidation of cases filed by individual complainants with the Republic of the Philippines, Department of Labor and Employment and the National Labor Relations Commission (NLRC) from 1998 through July 1999. The complaint is filed against Aris Philippines, Inc., Sara Lee Corporation, Sara Lee Philippines, Inc., Fashion Accessories Philippines, Inc., and Attorney Cesar C. Cruz (collectively, the “respondents”). The complaint primarily alleges unfair labor practices due to the termination of manufacturing operations in the Philippines by Aris Philippines, Inc., a former subsidiary of The Hillshire Brands Company. In 2006, the arbitrator ruled against the respondents and awarded the complainants PHP3,453,664,710 (approximately US$76 million) in damages and fees. The respondents appealed this ruling and it was subsequently set aside by the NLRC in December 2006. However, in a decision dated June 4, 2014, the Supreme Court of the Philippines set aside the NLRC’s December 2006 ruling as premature. The parties have filed numerous appeals, motions for reconsideration and petitions for review in these cases as to the merits of complainants’ claims and the appropriate amount of an appeal bond to be posted by the respondents. Certain of these appeals and motions remain pending before the NLRC and Supreme Court of the Philippines. On June 23, 2014, without admitting liability, The Hillshire Brands Company filed a motion requesting that the Supreme Court of the Philippines order dismissal with prejudice of all claims against it and its predecessors-in-interest in exchange for payments allocated by the court among the complainants in an amount not to exceed PHP342,287,800 (approximately US$7 million).

87



NOTE 21: QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)
 
 
 
 
in millions, except per share data
 
 
 
First
Quarter

 
Second
Quarter

 
Third
Quarter

 
Fourth
Quarter

2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
 
$
8,761

 
$
9,032

 
$
9,682

 
$
10,105

Gross profit
 
685

 
651

 
637

 
712

Operating income
 
412

 
361

 
351

 
306

Net income
 
252

 
210

 
258

 
136

Amounts attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   Net income from continuing operations
 
254

 
213

 
260

 
137

Net income attributable to Tyson
 
254

 
213

 
260

 
137

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income per share from continuing operations attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic (a)
 
$
0.76

 
$
0.64

 
$
0.75

 
$
0.37

Class B Basic
 
$
0.68

 
$
0.58

 
$
0.68

 
$
0.32

Diluted (a)
 
$
0.72

 
$
0.60

 
$
0.73

 
$
0.35

Net income per share attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic (a)
 
$
0.76

 
$
0.64

 
$
0.75

 
$
0.37

Class B Basic
 
$
0.68

 
$
0.58

 
$
0.68

 
$
0.32

Diluted (a)
 
$
0.72

 
$
0.60

 
$
0.73

 
$
0.35

2013
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
 
$
8,366

 
$
8,383

 
$
8,731

 
$
8,894

Gross profit
 
539

 
468

 
682

 
669

Operating income
 
304

 
236

 
419

 
416

Net income
 
168

 
106

 
245

 
259

Amounts attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   Net income from continuing operations
 
177

 
157

 
253

 
261

   Net loss from discontinued operation
 
(4
)
 
(62
)
 
(4
)
 

Net income attributable to Tyson
 
173

 
95

 
249

 
261

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income per share from continuing operations attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
 
$
0.51

 
$
0.45

 
$
0.73

 
$
0.77

Class B Basic
 
$
0.46

 
$
0.40

 
$
0.66

 
$
0.70

Diluted
 
$
0.49

 
$
0.43

 
$
0.69

 
$
0.70

Net loss per share from discontinued operation attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
 
$
(0.01
)
 
$
(0.18
)
 
$
(0.01
)
 
$

Class B Basic
 
$
(0.01
)
 
$
(0.15
)
 
$
(0.02
)
 
$

Diluted
 
$
(0.01
)
 
$
(0.17
)
 
$
(0.01
)
 
$

Net income per share attributable to Tyson:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Class A Basic
 
$
0.50

 
$
0.27

 
$
0.72

 
$
0.77

Class B Basic
 
$
0.45

 
$
0.25

 
$
0.64

 
$
0.70

Diluted
 
$
0.48

 
$
0.26

 
$
0.68

 
$
0.70


(a) The sum of the quarterly earnings per share amounts will not equal the total for the year due to the effects of rounding and dilution impact as a result of issuing Class A shares and tangible equity units in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2014.

88



Third quarter fiscal 2014 net income included a $29 million pretax expense related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition fees paid to third parties, a $49 million pretax expense related to the closure of three Prepared Foods facilities and a $40 million unrecognized tax benefit gain.
Fourth quarter fiscal 2014 net income included a $42 million pretax impairment and other costs related to the sale of our Brazil operation and Mexico's undistributed earnings tax, $119 million pretax expense related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition, integration and costs associated with our Prepared Foods improvement plan, $40 million pretax expense related to the Hillshire Brands post-closing results, purchase price accounting adjustments and ongoing costs related to a legacy Hillshire Brands plant fire, $27 million pretax expense related to the Hillshire Brands acquisition financing incremental interest cost and a $12 million unrecognized tax benefit gain.
Second quarter fiscal 2013 net income included a $19 million currency translation adjustment gain recognized in conjunction with the receipt of proceeds constituting the final resolution of our investment in Canada and included a $56 million non-cash charge, reported as a discontinued operation, related to the impairment of Weifang.
NOTE 22: CONDENSED CONSOLIDATING FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
TFM Parent, our wholly-owned subsidiary, has fully and unconditionally guaranteed the 2016 Notes. Additionally, TFM Parent has fully and unconditionally guaranteed the 2022 Notes until such date TFM Parent has been released of its guarantee of both (i) Tyson's $1.25 billion revolving credit facility and (ii) the 2016 Notes, at which time TFM Parent's guarantee of the 2019, 2022, 2024, 2034 and 2044 Notes is permanently released. The following financial information presents condensed consolidating financial statements, which include Tyson Foods, Inc. (TFI Parent); TFM Parent; the Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries (Non-Guarantors) on a combined basis; the elimination entries necessary to consolidate TFI Parent, TFM Parent and the Non-Guarantors; and Tyson Foods, Inc. on a consolidated basis, and is provided as an alternative to providing separate financial statements for the guarantor.
Condensed Consolidating Statement of Income and Comprehensive Income for the year ended September 27, 2014
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Sales
$
579

 
$
21,924

 
$
16,926

 
$
(1,849
)
 
$
37,580

Cost of Sales
74

 
20,971

 
15,689

 
(1,839
)
 
34,895

Gross Profit
505

 
953

 
1,237

 
(10
)
 
2,685

Selling, General and Administrative
141

 
240

 
884

 
(10
)
 
1,255

Operating Income
364

 
713

 
353

 

 
1,430

Other (Income) Expense:

 

 

 

 

Interest expense, net
63

 
49

 
13

 

 
125

Other, net
67

 
(1
)
 
(13
)
 

 
53

Equity in net earnings of subsidiaries
(731
)
 
(43
)
 

 
774

 

Total Other (Income) Expense
(601
)
 
5

 

 
774

 
178

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Taxes
965

 
708

 
353

 
(774
)
 
1,252

Income Tax Expense
101

 
227

 
68

 

 
396

Income from Continuing Operations
864

 
481

 
285

 
(774
)
 
856

Loss from Discontinued Operation, Net of Tax

 

 

 

 

Net Income
864

 
481

 
285

 
(774
)
 
856

Less: Net Loss Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests

 

 
(8
)
 

 
(8
)
Net Income Attributable to Tyson
$
864

 
$
481

 
$
293

 
$
(774
)
 
$
864

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comprehensive Income (Loss)
$
817

 
$
449

 
$
243

 
$
(692
)
 
$
817

Less: Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Noncontrolling Interest

 

 
(8
)
 

 
(8
)
Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Tyson
$
817

 
$
449

 
$
251

 
$
(692
)
 
$
825


89



Condensed Consolidating Statement of Income and Comprehensive Income for the year ended September 28, 2013
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Sales
$
431

 
$
19,243

 
$
16,120

 
$
(1,420
)
 
$
34,374

Cost of Sales
40

 
18,464

 
14,932

 
(1,420
)
 
32,016

Gross Profit
391

 
779

 
1,188

 

 
2,358

Selling, General and Administrative
68

 
201

 
714

 

 
983

Operating Income
323

 
578

 
474

 

 
1,375

Other (Income) Expense:

 

 

 

 

Interest expense, net
36

 
62

 
40

 

 
138

Other, net
4

 
(1
)
 
(23
)
 

 
(20
)
Equity in net earnings of subsidiaries
(582
)
 
(40
)
 

 
622

 

Total Other (Income) Expense
(542
)
 
21

 
17

 
622

 
118

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Taxes
865

 
557

 
457

 
(622
)
 
1,257

Income Tax Expense
87

 
172

 
150

 

 
409

Income from Continuing Operations
778

 
385

 
307

 
(622
)
 
848

Loss from Discontinued Operation, Net of Tax

 

 
(70
)
 

 
(70
)
Net Income
778

 
385

 
237

 
(622
)
 
778

Less: Net Loss Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests

 

 

 

 

Net Income Attributable to Tyson
$
778

 
$
385

 
$
237

 
$
(622
)
 
$
778

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comprehensive Income (Loss)
$
733

 
$
380

 
$
212

 
$
(592
)
 
$
733

Less: Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests

 

 

 

 

Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Tyson
$
733

 
$
380

 
$
212

 
$
(592
)
 
$
733

Condensed Consolidating Statement of Income and Comprehensive Income for the year ended September 29, 2012
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Sales
$
352

 
$
18,832

 
$
15,152

 
$
(1,281
)
 
$
33,055

Cost of Sales
(4
)
 
18,088

 
14,061

 
(1,280
)
 
30,865

Gross Profit
356

 
744

 
1,091

 
(1
)
 
2,190

Selling, General and Administrative
59

 
205

 
641

 
(1
)
 
904

Operating Income
297

 
539

 
450

 

 
1,286

Other (Income) Expense:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest expense, net
49

 
143

 
152

 

 
344

Other, net
1

 

 
(24
)
 

 
(23
)
Equity in net earnings of subsidiaries
(427
)
 
(43
)
 

 
470

 

Total Other (Income) Expense
(377
)
 
100

 
128

 
470

 
321

Income from Continuing Operations before Income Taxes
674

 
439

 
322

 
(470
)
 
965

Income Tax Expense
91

 
130

 
130

 

 
351

Income from Continuing Operations
583

 
309

 
192

 
(470
)
 
614

Loss from Discontinued Operation, Net of Tax

 

 
(38
)
 

 
(38
)
Net Income
583

 
309

 
154

 
(470
)
 
576

Less: Net Loss Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests

 

 
(7
)
 

 
(7
)
Net Income Attributable to Tyson
$
583

 
$
309

 
$
161

 
$
(470
)
 
$
583

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comprehensive Income (Loss)
$
599

 
$
324

 
$
166

 
$
(497
)
 
$
592

Less: Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests

 

 
(7
)
 

 
(7
)
Comprehensive Income (Loss) Attributable to Tyson
$
599

 
$
324

 
$
173

 
$
(497
)
 
$
599


90



Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet as of September 27, 2014
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$

 
$
41

 
$
397

 
$

 
$
438

Accounts receivable, net
3

 
665

 
1,016

 

 
1,684

Inventories

 
1,272

 
2,002

 

 
3,274

Other current assets
42

 
78

 
379

 
(120
)
 
379

Assets held for sale
3

 

 
443

 

 
446

Total Current Assets
48

 
2,056

 
4,237

 
(120
)
 
6,221

Net Property, Plant and Equipment
30

 
932

 
4,168

 

 
5,130

Goodwill

 
881

 
5,825

 

 
6,706

Intangible Assets

 
15

 
5,261

 

 
5,276

Other Assets
204

 
148

 
326

 
(55
)
 
623

Investment in Subsidiaries
20,845

 
2,049

 

 
(22,894
)
 

Total Assets
$
21,127

 
$
6,081

 
$
19,817

 
$
(23,069
)
 
$
23,956

Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current Liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current debt
$
240

 
$

 
$
403

 
$

 
$
643

Accounts payable
35

 
755

 
1,016

 

 
1,806

Other current liabilities
4,718

 
235

 
921

 
(4,667
)
 
1,207

Liabilities held for sale

 

 
141

 

 
141

Total Current Liabilities
4,993

 
990

 
2,481

 
(4,667
)
 
3,797

Long-Term Debt
7,056

 
2

 
532

 
(55
)
 
7,535

Deferred Income Taxes
21

 
96

 
2,333

 

 
2,450

Other Liabilities
167

 
125

 
978

 

 
1,270

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Tyson Shareholders’ Equity
8,890

 
4,868

 
13,479

 
(18,347
)
 
8,890

Noncontrolling Interests

 

 
14

 

 
14

Total Shareholders’ Equity
8,890

 
4,868

 
13,493

 
(18,347
)
 
8,904

Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
$
21,127

 
$
6,081

 
$
19,817

 
$
(23,069
)
 
$
23,956


91



Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet as of September 28, 2013
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$

 
$
21

 
$
1,124

 
$

 
$
1,145

Accounts receivable, net

 
571

 
926

 

 
1,497

Inventories

 
1,039

 
1,778

 

 
2,817

Other current assets
351

 
88

 
117

 
(411
)
 
145

Total Current Assets
351

 
1,719

 
3,945

 
(411
)
 
5,604

Net Property, Plant and Equipment
32

 
891

 
3,130

 

 
4,053

Goodwill

 
881

 
1,021

 

 
1,902

Intangible Assets

 
21

 
117

 

 
138

Other Assets
895

 
162

 
244

 
(821
)
 
480

Investment in Subsidiaries
11,975

 
2,035

 

 
(14,010
)
 

Total Assets
$
13,253

 
$
5,709

 
$
8,457

 
$
(15,242
)
 
$
12,177

Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current Liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current debt
$
457

 
$
132

 
$
251

 
$
(327
)
 
$
513

Accounts payable
27

 
575

 
757

 

 
1,359

Other current liabilities
4,625

 
200

 
901

 
(4,588
)
 
1,138

Total Current Liabilities
5,109

 
907

 
1,909

 
(4,915
)
 
3,010

Long-Term Debt
1,770

 
679

 
241

 
(795
)
 
1,895

Deferred Income Taxes
24

 
93

 
362

 

 
479

Other Liabilities
149

 
155

 
282

 
(26
)
 
560

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Tyson Shareholders’ Equity
6,201

 
3,875

 
5,631

 
(9,506
)
 
6,201

Noncontrolling Interests

 

 
32

 

 
32

Total Shareholders’ Equity
6,201

 
3,875

 
5,663

 
(9,506
)
 
6,233

Total Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
$
13,253

 
$
5,709

 
$
8,457

 
$
(15,242
)
 
$
12,177

Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows for the year ended September 27, 2014
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Cash Provided by (Used for) Operating Activities
$
132

 
$
431

 
$
660

 
$
(45
)
 
$
1,178

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Additions to property, plant and equipment
(1
)
 
(147
)
 
(484
)
 

 
(632
)
(Purchases of)/Proceeds from marketable securities, net

 

 
15

 

 
15

Proceeds from notes receivable

 

 

 

 

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired
(8,193
)
 

 

 

 
(8,193
)
Other, net
5

 
2

 
3

 

 
10

Cash Provided by (Used for) Investing Activities
(8,189
)
 
(145
)
 
(466
)
 

 
(8,800
)
Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in debt
5,154

 

 
(12
)
 

 
5,142

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net of issuance costs
873

 

 

 

 
873

Proceeds from issuance of equity component of tangible equity units
1,255

 

 

 

 
1,255

Purchases of Tyson Class A common stock
(295
)
 

 

 

 
(295
)
Dividends
(104
)
 

 
(45
)
 
45

 
(104
)
Stock options exercised
67

 

 

 

 
67

Other, net
(22
)
 

 
(1
)
 

 
(23
)
Net change in intercompany balances
1,129

 
(266
)
 
(863
)
 

 

Cash Provided by (Used for) Financing Activities
8,057

 
(266
)
 
(921
)
 
45

 
6,915

Effect of Exchange Rate Change on Cash

 

 

 

 

Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents

 
20

 
(727
)
 

 
(707
)
Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Year

 
21

 
1,124

 

 
1,145

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period
$

 
$
41

 
$
397

 
$

 
$
438


92



Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows for the year ended September 28, 2013
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Cash Provided by (Used for) Operating Activities
$
294

 
$
337

 
$
696

 
$
(13
)
 
$
1,314

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Additions to property, plant and equipment
(4
)
 
(113
)
 
(441
)
 

 
(558
)
(Purchases of)/Proceeds from marketable securities, net

 
(13
)
 
(5
)
 

 
(18
)
Proceeds from notes receivable

 

 

 

 

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired

 

 
(106
)
 

 
(106
)
Other, net

 
3

 
36

 

 
39

Cash Provided by (Used for) Investing Activities
(4
)
 
(123
)
 
(516
)
 

 
(643
)
Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in debt
5

 

 
(28
)
 

 
(23
)
Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net of issuance costs

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from issuance of equity component of tangible equity units

 

 

 

 

Purchases of Tyson Class A common stock
(614
)
 

 

 

 
(614
)
Dividends
(104
)
 

 
(13
)
 
13

 
(104
)
Stock options exercised
123

 

 

 

 
123

Other, net
18

 

 

 

 
18

Net change in intercompany balances
281

 
(202
)
 
(79
)
 

 

Cash Provided by (Used for) Financing Activities
(291
)
 
(202
)
 
(120
)
 
13

 
(600
)
Effect of Exchange Rate Change on Cash

 

 
3

 

 
3

Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents
(1
)
 
12

 
63

 

 
74

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Year
1

 
9

 
1,061

 

 
1,071

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period
$

 
$
21

 
$
1,124

 
$

 
$
1,145

Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows for the year ended September 29, 2012
 
in millions
 
 
TFI
Parent

 
TFM
Parent

 
Non-
Guarantors

 
Eliminations

 
Total

Cash Provided by (Used for) Operating Activities
$
312

 
$
438

 
$
447

 
$
(10
)
 
$
1,187

Cash Flows from Investing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Additions to property, plant and equipment
(1
)
 
(104
)
 
(585
)
 

 
(690
)
(Purchases of)/Proceeds from marketable securities, net

 
(7
)
 
(4
)
 

 
(11
)
Proceeds from notes receivable

 

 

 

 

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired

 

 

 

 

Other, net
1

 
5

 
35

 

 
41

Cash Provided by (Used for) Investing Activities

 
(106
)
 
(554
)
 

 
(660
)
Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in debt
107

 

 
16

 

 
123

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, net of issuance costs

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from issuance of equity component of tangible equity units

 

 

 

 

Purchases of Tyson Class A common stock
(264
)
 

 

 

 
(264
)
Dividends
(57
)
 

 
(10
)
 
10

 
(57
)
Stock options exercised
34

 

 

 

 
34

Other, net
(8
)
 

 
1

 

 
(7
)
Net change in intercompany balances
(124
)
 
(324
)
 
448

 

 

Cash Provided by (Used for) Financing Activities
(312
)
 
(324
)
 
455

 
10

 
(171
)
Effect of Exchange Rate Change on Cash

 

 
(1
)
 

 
(1
)
Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents

 
8

 
347

 

 
355

Cash and Cash Equivalents at Beginning of Year
1

 
1

 
714

 

 
716

Cash and Cash Equivalents at End of Period
$
1

 
$
9

 
$
1,061

 
$

 
$
1,071


93



Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of
Tyson Foods, Inc.

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, shareholders’ equity and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Tyson Foods, Inc. and its subsidiaries at September 27, 2014 and September 28, 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 27, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. In addition, in our opinion, the financial statement schedule listed in the index appearing under Item 15(a) presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein when read in conjunction with the related consolidated financial statements. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of September 27, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (1992) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company's management is responsible for these financial statements and financial statement schedule, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management's Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements, on the financial statement schedule, and on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

As described in Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting, management has excluded The Hillshire Brands Company from its assessment of internal control over financial reporting as of September 27, 2014 because it was acquired by the Company in a purchase business combination during August 2014. We have also excluded The Hillshire Brands Company from our audit of internal control over financial reporting. The Hillshire Brands Company is a wholly-owned subsidiary whose total assets and total revenues represent 10% and 1%, respectively, of the related consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended September 27, 2014.

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
Fayetteville, AR
November 17, 2014

94



ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
Not applicable.
ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures
An evaluation was performed, under the supervision and with the participation of management, including the Chief Executive Officer (CEO) and the Chief Financial Officer (CFO), of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the 1934 Act)). Based on that evaluation, the CEO and CFO concluded that, as of September 27, 2014, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective.
Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
In the quarter ended September 27, 2014, there have been no changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) of the 1934 Act. Our internal control over financial reporting was designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Management conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of September 27, 2014. In making this assessment, we used criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (1992).
Based on this evaluation under the framework in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (1992) issued by COSO, Management concluded the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of September 27, 2014.
Management excluded The Hillshire Brands Company from our assessment of internal control over financial reporting as of September 27, 2014 because it was acquired by the Company in a purchase business combination in August 2014. The Hillshire Brands Company is a wholly-owned subsidiary whose total assets and total revenues represent 10% and 1%, respectively, of the related consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended September 27, 2014.
The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, who has audited the fiscal 2014 financial statements included in this Form 10-K has also audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. Their report appears in Part II, Item 8.
ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION
None.

95



PART III
ITEM 10. DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
See information set forth under the captions “Election of Directors” and “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for the Company’s Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held January 30, 2015 (the “Proxy Statement”), which information is incorporated herein by reference. Pursuant to general instruction G(3) of Annual Report on Form 10-K, certain information concerning our executive officers is included under the caption “Executive Officers of the Company” in Part I of this Report.
We have a code of ethics as defined in Item 406 of Regulation S-K, which code applies to all of our directors and employees, including our principal executive officers, principal financial officer, principal accounting officer or controller, and persons performing similar functions. This code of ethics, titled “Tyson Foods, Inc. Code of Conduct,” is available, free of charge on our website at http://ir.tyson.com.
ITEM 11. EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
See the information set forth under the captions “Executive Compensation,” “Director Compensation For Fiscal Year 2014,” “Compensation Discussion and Analysis,” “Report of the Compensation and Leadership Development Committee,” and “Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation” in the Proxy Statement, which information is incorporated herein by reference. However, pursuant to instructions to Item 407(e)(5) of the Securities and Exchange Commission Regulation S-K, the material appearing under the sub-heading “Report of the Compensation and Leadership Development Committee” shall not be deemed to be “filed” with the Commission, other than as provided in this Item 11.
ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
See the information included under the captions “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners” and “Security Ownership of Management” in the Proxy Statement, which information is incorporated herein by reference.
Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans
The following information reflects certain information about our equity compensation plans as of September 27, 2014:
 
Equity Compensation Plan Information
 
Number of
Securities to be
issued upon
exercise of
outstanding
options

 
Weighted
average
exercise price
of outstanding
options

 
Number of Securities
remaining available for
future issuance under
equity compensation plans
(excluding Securities
reflected in the first column)

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders
13,724,409

 
$
21.30

 
55,345,262

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

 

 

Total
13,724,409

 
$
21.30

 
55,345,262

(a)
Shares available for future issuance as of September 27, 2014, under the Stock Incentive Plan (30,428,186), the Employee Stock Purchase Plan (17,269,468) and the Retirement Savings Plan (7,647,608)

ITEM 13. CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
See the information included under the captions “Election of Directors” and “Certain Transactions” in the Proxy Statement, which information is incorporated herein by reference.
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
See the information included under the captions “Audit Fees,” “Audit-Related Fees,” “Tax Fees,” “All Other Fees,” and “Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policy” in the Proxy Statement, which information is incorporated herein by reference.

96



PART IV
ITEM 15. EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
 
(a)
The following documents are filed as a part of this report:
Consolidated Statements of Income
for the three years ended September 27, 2014
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
for the three years ended September 27, 2014
Consolidated Balance Sheets at
September 27, 2014, and September 28, 2013
Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity
for the three years ended September 27, 2014
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
for the three years ended September 27, 2014
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
Financial Statement Schedule - Schedule II Valuation and Qualifying
Accounts for the three years ended September 27, 2014
All other schedules are omitted because they are neither applicable nor required.
The exhibits filed with this report are listed in the Exhibit Index at the end of Item 15.

97



EXHIBIT INDEX
Exhibit No.
 
2.1
 
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of July 1, 2014, by and between the Company and Hillshire Brands (previously filed as Exhibit 2.1 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed July 2, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
2.2
 
Share Purchase Agreement dated November 9, 2010 by and among BBU, Inc., Grupo Bimbo, S.A.B. DE C.V. and Hillshire Brands Corporation (previously filed as Exhibit 2.1 to Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended January 1, 2011 by The Hillshire Brands Company, Commission File No. 001-03344, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
2.3
 
Master Separation Agreement by and between Sara Lee Corporation, D.E MASTER BLENDERS 1753 B.V. and DE US, Inc., dated as of June 15, 2012 (previously filed as Exhibit 2.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K filed June 15, 2012 by The Hillshire Brands Company, Commission File No. 001-03344, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
3.1
 
Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company (previously filed as Exhibit 3.1 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 3, 1998, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
3.2
 
Fifth Amended and Restated By-laws of the Company (previously filed as Exhibit 3.2 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed for the period ended June 29, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.1
 
Indenture dated June 1, 1995 by and between the Company and The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A., as Trustee (the “Company Indenture”) (previously filed as Exhibit 4 to Registration Statement on Form S-3, filed with the Commission on December 18, 1997, Registration No. 333-42525, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.2
 
Form of 7.0% Note due January 15, 2028 issued under the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended December 27, 1997, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.3
 
Form of 7.0% Note due May 1, 2018 issued under the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 28, 1998, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.4
 
Form of 6.60% Senior Notes due April 1, 2016 issued under the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed March 22, 2006, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.5
 
Supplemental Indenture, dated as of September 18, 2006, by and among the Company, Tyson Fresh Meats, Inc. and JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association, supplementing the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed September 19, 2006, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.6
 
Supplemental Indenture dated as of September 15, 2008, by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.)), as Trustee (including the form of 3.25% Convertible Senior Notes due 2013), supplementing the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed September 15, 2008, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.7
 
Supplemental Indenture dated as of June 13, 2012, by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.)), as Trustee, supplementing the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed June 13, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.8
 
Form of 4.50% Senior Note due 2022 (previously filed as Exhibit 4.2 and included in Exhibit 4.1 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8‑K filed June 13, 2012, Commission File No. 001‑14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.9
 
Supplemental Indenture dated as of August 8, 2014, by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.)), as Trustee, supplementing the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.10
 
Form of 2.65% Senior Note due 2019 (included in Exhibit 4.2 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8‑K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001‑14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 

98



4.11
 
Supplemental Indenture dated as of August 8, 2014, by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.)), as Trustee, supplementing the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.4 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.12
 
Form of 3.95% Senior Note due 2024 (included in Exhibit 4.4 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8‑K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001‑14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.13
 
Supplemental Indenture dated as of August 8, 2014, by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.)), as Trustee, supplementing the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.6 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.14
 
Form of 4.875% Senior Note due 2034 (included in Exhibit 4.6 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8‑K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001‑14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.15
 
Supplemental Indenture dated as of August 8, 2014, by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association (as successor to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (formerly The Chase Manhattan Bank, N.A.)), as Trustee, supplementing the Company Indenture (previously filed as Exhibit 4.8 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.16
 
Form of 5.15% Senior Note due 2044 (included in Exhibit 4.8 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8‑K filed August 8, 2014, Commission File No. 001‑14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.17
 
Purchase Contract Agreement dated as of August 5, 2014 by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as Purchase Contract Agent (included in Exhibit 4.1 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 5, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.18
 
Form of Unit (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 5, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.19
 
Form of Purchase Contract (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 5, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.20
 
Supplemental Indenture dated as of August 5, 2014 by and between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee, supplementing the Company Indenture (included in Exhibit 4.5 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 5, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.21
 
Form of Amortizing Note (previously filed as Exhibit 4.5 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed August 5, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.22
 
Indenture dated October 2, 1990 between Sara Lee Corporation and Continental Bank, N.A., as Trustee (the “Sara Lee Indenture”) (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 of Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement No. 33-33603 on Form S-3 by Sara Lee Corporation, predecessor in interest to The Hillshire Brands Company, filed with the Commission on October 5, 1990, Commission File No. 001-03344, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.23
 
Form of 2.75% Notes due 2015 issued pursuant to the Sara Lee Indenture (included in Exhibit 4.1 to Current Report on Form 8-K dated September 7, 2010 by The Hillshire Brands Company, Commission File No. 001-03344, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.24
 
Form of 4.10% Notes due 2020 issued pursuant to the Sara Lee Indenture (included in Exhibit 4.2 to Current Report on Form 8-K dated September 7, 2010 by The Hillshire Brands Company, Commission File No. 001-03344, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
4.25
 
Form of 6.13% Notes due 2032 issued pursuant to the Sara Lee Indenture.
 
 
 
10.1
 
Second Amended and Restated Commitment Letter entered into as of June 9, 2014, among the Company, Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc. and JPMorgan Chase Bank (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed June 10, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.2
 
Credit Agreement, dated as of September 25, 2014, by and among the Company, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as the Administrative Agent, and certain other lenders party thereto (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed September 29, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 

99



10.3
 
364-Day Bridge Term Loan Agreement, dated as of July 15, 2014, by and among the Company, Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., as the Administrative Agent, and certain other lenders party thereto (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed July 17, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.4
 
Term Loan Agreement, dated as of July 15, 2014, by and among the Company, Morgan Stanley Senior Funding, Inc., as the Administrative Agent, and certain other lenders party thereto (previously filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed July 17, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.5
 
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, dated as of May 1, 2014, by and between the Company and John Tyson (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended March 29, 2014, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.6
 
Employment Agreement, dated August 27, 2012, by and between the Company and Curt T. Calaway (previously filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.7
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 14, 2012, by and between the Company and Donald J. Smith (previously filed as Exhibit 10.12 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.8
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 14, 2012, by and between the Company and David Van Bebber (previously filed as Exhibit 10.14 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.9
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 14, 2012, by and between the Company and Dennis Leatherby (previously filed as Exhibit 10.15 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.10
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 14, 2012, by and between the Company and Kenneth J. Kimbro (previously filed as Exhibit 10.16 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.11
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 14, 2012, by and between the Company and Donnie D. King (previously filed as Exhibit 10.17 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.12
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 15, 2013, by and between the Company and Donnie D. King(previously filed as Exhibit 10.17 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.13
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 14, 2012, by and between the Company and Noel W. White (previously filed as Exhibit 10.18 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.14
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 15, 2013, by and between the Company and Noel W. White (previously filed as Exhibit 10.19 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.15
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 15, 2013, by and between the Company and Howell P. Carper(previously filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.16
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 12, 2013, by and between the Company and Stephen R. Stouffer(previously filed as Exhibit 10.21 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.17
 
Employment Agreement, dated November 14, 2012, by and between the Company and James V. Lochner (previously filed as Exhibit 10.13 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.18
 
Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated November 15, 2013, by and between the Company and James V. Lochner (previously filed as Exhibit 10.12 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.19
 
Employment Agreement, dated August 29, 2014, by and between the Company and Andrew P. Callahan.
 
 
 
10.20
 
Employment Agreement, dated August 29, 2014, by and between the Company and Sobhana (Sally) Grimes.
 
 
 
10.21
 
Employment Agreement, dated August 29, 2014, by and between the Company and Thomas P. Hayes.
 
 
 

100



10.22
 
Employment Agreement, dated August 29, 2014, by and between the Company and Mary Oleksiuk.
 
 
 
10.23
 
Form of Retention Award Letter Agreement, dated August 29, 2014, by and between the Company and Andrew Callahan, Sobhana (Sally) Grimes, Thomas Hayes and Mary Oleksiuk.
 
 
 
10.24
 
Indemnity Agreement, dated as of September 28, 2007, between the Company and John Tyson (previously filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed September 28, 2007, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.25
 
Form of Indemnity Agreement between Tyson Foods, Inc. and its directors and certain executive officers (previously filed as Exhibit 10(t) to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1995, Commission File No. 0-3400, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.26
 
Tyson Foods, Inc. Annual Incentive Compensation Plan for Senior Executives adopted February 4, 2005, and reapproved February 5, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.34 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 1, 2005, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.27
 
Amended and Restated Tyson Foods, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan, effective as of February 1, 2013 (previously filed as Exhibit 99.2 to Registration Statement on Form S-8, filed with the Commission on February 22, 2013, Registration No. 333-186797, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.28
 
First Amendment to the Tyson Foods, Inc. Employee Stock Purchase Plan, effective February 1, 2013 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.29
 
Amended and Restated Executive Savings Plan of Tyson Foods, Inc. effective January 1, 2013 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.27 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.30
 
Amended and Restated Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective February 1, 2013 (previously filed as Exhibit 99.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-8, filed with the Commission on February 22, 2013, Registration No. 333-186797, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.31
 
First Amendment to the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective May 1, 2013 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.29 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.32
 
Amended and Restated Tyson Foods, Inc. Supplemental Executive Retirement and Life Insurance Premium Plan effective November 14, 2013 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.30 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-147-4, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.33
 
Retirement Savings Plan of Tyson Foods, Inc. effective January 1, 2011 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.33 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 1, 2011, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.34
 
First Amendment to the Retirement Savings Plan of Tyson Foods, Inc., as Amended and Restated as of January 1, 2011 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.32 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.35
 
Amended and Restated Retirement Income Plan of IBP, inc. effective August 1, 2000, and Amendment to Freeze the Retirement Income Plan of IBP, inc. effective December 31, 2002 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.46 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 27, 2008, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.36
 
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement pursuant to which restricted stock awards were granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan prior to July 31, 2009 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.48 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 2, 2004, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.37
 
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement pursuant to which restricted stock awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective July 31, 2009 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.41 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 3, 2009, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.38
 
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement pursuant to which restricted stock awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective January 1, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.41 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 2, 2010, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 

101



10.39
 
Form of Stock Incentive Agreement with key employees and contracted employees at band level 3-9 pursuant to which restricted stock awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective October 26, 2012 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.38 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.40
 
Form of Stock Incentive Agreement with the remaining contracted employees pursuant to which restricted stock awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective October 26, 2012 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.39 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.41
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement pursuant to which stock option awards were granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan prior to July 31, 2009 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.49 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 2, 2004, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.42
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective July 31, 2009 through February 3, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.43 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 2, 2010, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.43
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective February 4, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.44 to the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 2, 2010, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.44
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement with non-contracted employees pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective November 29, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.40 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 1, 2011, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.45
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement with contracted employees at band level 1-5 pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective November 29, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.41 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 1, 2011, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.46
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement with key employees and contracted employees at band level 6-9 pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective November 29, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.42 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 1, 2011, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.47
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement with non-contracted employees pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective November 28, 2011 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.46 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.48
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement with contracted employees at band level 1-5 pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective November 28, 2011 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.47 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.49
 
Form of Stock Option Grant Agreement with key employees and contracted employees at band level 6-9 pursuant to which stock option awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective November 28, 2011 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.48 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.50
 
Form of Stock Incentive Agreement pursuant to which stock options are granted to contracted employees under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective October 26, 2012 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.49 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.51
 
Form of Stock Incentive Agreement pursuant to which stock options are granted to non-contracted employees under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective October 26, 2012 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.50 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.52
 
Form of Performance Stock Award Agreement pursuant to which performance stock awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective October 4, 2010 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.44 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended October 1, 2011, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 

102



10.53
 
Form of Performance Stock Award Agreement pursuant to which performance stock awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective October 3, 2011 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.52 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.54
 
Form of Stock Incentive Agreement pursuant to which performance stock awards are granted under the Tyson Foods, Inc. 2000 Stock Incentive Plan effective October 26, 2012 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.53 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.55
 
Tyson Foods, Inc. Severance Pay Plan for Contracted Employees, effective October 31, 2012 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.54 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 29, 2012, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).

 
 
10.56
 
Tax Sharing Agreement, dated as of June 15, 2012, by and among Sara Lee Corporation, D.E MASTER BLENDERS 1753 B.V. and DE US, Inc. (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 15, 2012 by The Hillshire Brands Company, Commission File No. 001-03344, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
10.57
 
First Amendment to the Company's Supplemental Executive Retirement and Life Insurance Premium Plan as Amended and Restated as of November 14, 2014.
 
 
 
12.1
 
Calculation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges.
 
 
 
14.1
 
Code of Conduct of the Company (previously filed as Exhibit 14.1 to the Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 28, 2013, Commission File No. 001-14704, and incorporated herein by reference).
 
 
 
21
 
Subsidiaries of the Company.
 
 
 
23
 
Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers, LLP.
 
 
 
31.1
 
Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to SEC Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a), as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
 
31.2
 
Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to SEC Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a), as adopted pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
 
32.1
 
Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
 
32.2
 
Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
 
101
 
The following financial information from our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended September 27, 2014, formatted in XBRL (eXtensible Business Reporting Language): (i) Consolidated Statements of Income, (ii) Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income, (iii) Consolidated Balance Sheets, (iv) Consolidated Statements of Shareholders' Equity, (v) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, (vi) the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements, and (vii) Financial Statement Schedule.

103



SIGNATURES
Pursuant to requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
TYSON FOODS, INC.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Dennis Leatherby
 
November 17, 2014
 
 
Dennis Leatherby
 
 
 
 
Executive Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer
 
 

104



Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the date indicated.
 
/s/ Kathleen M. Bader
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Kathleen M. Bader
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Gaurdie E. Banister Jr.
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Gaurdie E. Banister Jr.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Curt T. Calaway
 
Senior Vice President, Controller and
 
November 17, 2014
Curt T. Calaway
 
Chief Accounting Officer
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Jim Kever
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Jim Kever
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Dennis Leatherby
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
 
November 17, 2014
Dennis Leatherby
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Kevin M. McNamara
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Kevin M. McNamara
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Brad T. Sauer
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Brad T. Sauer
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Donnie Smith
 
President and Chief Executive Officer
 
November 17, 2014
Donnie Smith
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Robert C. Thurber
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Robert C. Thurber
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Barbara A. Tyson
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Barbara A. Tyson
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ John Tyson
 
Chairman of the Board of Directors
 
November 17, 2014
John Tyson
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ Albert C. Zapanta
 
Director
 
November 17, 2014
Albert C. Zapanta
 
 
 
 

105



FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULE
TYSON FOODS, INC.
SCHEDULE II
VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
Three Years Ended September 27, 2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
in millions

 
 
 
 
Additions
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at
Beginning
of Period

 
Charged to
Costs and
Expenses

 
Charged to
Other Accounts

 
(Deductions)

 
Balance at End
of Period

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
$
46

 
$
5

 
$

 
$
(17
)
 
$
34

2013
 
33

 
17

 

 
(4
)
 
46

2012
 
31

 
7

 

 
(5
)
 
33

Inventory Lower of Cost or Market Allowance:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
$
16

 
$
14

 
$

 
$
(23
)
 
$
7

2013
 
24

 
49

 

 
(57
)
 
16

2012
 
6

 
52

 

 
(34
)
 
24

Valuation Allowance on Deferred Tax Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
$
77

 
$
26

 
$
13

 
$
(65
)
 
$
51

2013
 
78

 
8

 

 
(9
)
 
77

2012
 
92

 
16

 

 
(30
)
 
78


106